]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
* xterm.c (handle_one_xevent): Check that f is not NULL before
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
143
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
145
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
150
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
157
158 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
159
160 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 #ifdef USE_XIM
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 #else
164 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
165 #endif
166
167 \f
168
169 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
170
171 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
172
173 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
174 start. */
175
176 static int any_help_event_p;
177
178 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
179 static Lisp_Object last_window;
180
181 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
182
183 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
184
185 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
186 use. */
187
188 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
189
190 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
191 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
192 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
193 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
194
195 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
196
197 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
198 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
199 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
200 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
201
202 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
203
204 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
205
206 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
207
208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
209 /* The application context for Xt use. */
210 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
211 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
212 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
213
214 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
215
216 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
217
218 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
219 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
220
221 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
222
223 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
224 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
225 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
226
227 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
228
229 /* Mouse movement.
230
231 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
232 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
233 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
234 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
235
236 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
237
238 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
239 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
240 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
241 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
242 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
243 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
244 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
245 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
246 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
247 is off. */
248
249 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
250
251 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
252 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
253 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
254
255 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
256
257 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
258 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
259 an ordinary motion.
260
261 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
262 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
263 event. */
264
265 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
266
267 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
268 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
269 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
270 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
271 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
272 it's somewhat accurate. */
273
274 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
275
276 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
277 events. */
278
279 #ifdef __STDC__
280 static int volatile input_signal_count;
281 #else
282 static int input_signal_count;
283 #endif
284
285 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
286
287 static int x_noop_count;
288
289 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
290
291 extern char **initial_argv;
292 extern int initial_argc;
293
294 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
295
296 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
297
298 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
299
300 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
301
302 extern int errno;
303
304 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
305
306 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
307
308 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
309
310 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
311 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
312 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
313
314 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
315 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
316
317 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
318 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
319
320 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
321 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
322 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
323 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
324 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
325
326 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
327 void x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
328 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((void));
329 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
330 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
331 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
332 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
333 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
334 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
335 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
336 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
337 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
338 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
339 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
340 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
341 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
343 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
344 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
345 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
346 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
347 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
348 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
349 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
350 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
351 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
352 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
353 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
354 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
355 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
356 enum text_cursor_kinds));
357
358 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
359 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
360 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
361 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
362 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
363 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
364 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
365 enum scroll_bar_part *,
366 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
367 unsigned long *));
368 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
369 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
370 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
371 int *, struct input_event *));
372
373
374 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
375
376 static void
377 x_flush (f)
378 struct frame *f;
379 {
380 BLOCK_INPUT;
381 if (f == NULL)
382 {
383 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
384 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
385 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
386 }
387 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
388 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
390 }
391
392
393 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
394 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
395 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
396 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
397 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
398 performance. */
399
400 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
401
402 \f
403 /***********************************************************************
404 Debugging
405 ***********************************************************************/
406
407 #if 0
408
409 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
410 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
411
412 struct record
413 {
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
416 };
417
418 struct record event_record[100];
419
420 int event_record_index;
421
422 record_event (locus, type)
423 char *locus;
424 int type;
425 {
426 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
427 event_record_index = 0;
428
429 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
430 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
431 event_record_index++;
432 }
433
434 #endif /* 0 */
435
436
437 \f
438 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
439
440 struct x_display_info *
441 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
442 Display *dpy;
443 {
444 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
445
446 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
447 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
448 return dpyinfo;
449
450 return 0;
451 }
452
453
454 \f
455 /***********************************************************************
456 Starting and ending an update
457 ***********************************************************************/
458
459 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
460 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
461 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
462 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
463 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
464
465 static void
466 x_update_begin (f)
467 struct frame *f;
468 {
469 /* Nothing to do. */
470 }
471
472
473 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
474 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
475 position of W. */
476
477 static void
478 x_update_window_begin (w)
479 struct window *w;
480 {
481 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
482 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
483
484 updated_window = w;
485 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
486
487 BLOCK_INPUT;
488
489 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
490 {
491 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
492 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
493
494 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
495 highlighting. */
496 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
497 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
498
499 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
500 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
501 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
502 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
503 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
504 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
505
506 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
507 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
508 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
509 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
510 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
511 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
512 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
513 {
514 int i;
515
516 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
517 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
518 break;
519
520 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
521 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
522 }
523 #endif /* 0 */
524 }
525
526 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
527 }
528
529
530 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
531
532 static void
533 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
534 struct window *w;
535 int x, y0, y1;
536 {
537 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
538 struct face *face;
539
540 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
541 if (face)
542 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
543 face->foreground);
544
545 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
546 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
547 }
548
549 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
550
551 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
552 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
553
554 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
555 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
556 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
557
558 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
559 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
560 here. */
561
562 static void
563 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
564 struct window *w;
565 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
566 {
567 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
568
569 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
570 {
571 BLOCK_INPUT;
572
573 if (cursor_on_p)
574 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
575 output_cursor.vpos,
576 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
577
578 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
579 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
580
581 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
582 }
583
584 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
585 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
586 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
587 {
588 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
590 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
591 }
592
593 updated_window = NULL;
594 }
595
596
597 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
598 update_end. */
599
600 static void
601 x_update_end (f)
602 struct frame *f;
603 {
604 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
605 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
606
607 #ifndef XFlush
608 BLOCK_INPUT;
609 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
611 #endif
612 }
613
614
615 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
616 complete update has been performed. The global variable
617 updated_window is not available here. */
618
619 static void
620 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
621 struct frame *f;
622 {
623 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
624 {
625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
626
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
628 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
629 {
630 BLOCK_INPUT;
631 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
632 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
633 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
635 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
636 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
637 }
638 }
639 }
640
641
642 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
643 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
644 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
645 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
646 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
647 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
648
649 static void
650 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
651 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
652 {
653 struct window *w = updated_window;
654 struct frame *f;
655 int width, height;
656
657 xassert (w);
658
659 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
660 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
661
662 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
663 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
664 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
665 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
666 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
667 overhead is very small. */
668 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
669 && desired_row->full_width_p
670 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
671 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
672 width != 0)
673 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
674 height > 0))
675 {
676 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
677
678 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
679 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
680 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
681 y -= width;
682
683 BLOCK_INPUT;
684 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
685 0, y, width, height, False);
686 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
687 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
688 y, width, height, False);
689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
690 }
691 }
692
693 static void
694 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
695 struct window *w;
696 struct glyph_row *row;
697 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
698 {
699 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
700 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
701 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
702 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
703 struct face *face = p->face;
704 int rowY;
705
706 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
707 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
708 if (p->y < rowY)
709 {
710 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
711 visible last row. */
712 int oldY = row->y;
713 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
714 row->visible_height = p->h;
715 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
716 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
717 row->y = oldY;
718 row->visible_height = oldVH;
719 }
720 else
721 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
722
723 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
724 {
725 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
726 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
727 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
728 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
729 if (face->stipple)
730 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
731 else
732 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
733
734 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
735 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
736
737 if (!face->stipple)
738 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
739 }
740
741 if (p->which)
742 {
743 unsigned char *bits;
744 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
745 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
746 XGCValues gcv;
747
748 if (p->wd > 8)
749 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
750 else
751 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
752
753 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
754 by the server. */
755 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
756 (p->cursor_p
757 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
758 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
759 : face->foreground),
760 face->background, depth);
761
762 if (p->overlay_p)
763 {
764 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
765 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
766 bits, p->wd, p->h,
767 1, 0, 1);
768 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
769 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
770 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
771 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
772 }
773
774 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
775 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
776 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
777
778 if (p->overlay_p)
779 {
780 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
781 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
782 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
783 }
784 }
785
786 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
787 }
788
789 \f
790
791 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
792 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
793 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
794 rarely happens). */
795
796 static void
797 XTset_terminal_modes ()
798 {
799 }
800
801 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
802 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
803
804 static void
805 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
806 {
807 }
808
809
810 \f
811 /***********************************************************************
812 Display Iterator
813 ***********************************************************************/
814
815 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
816
817 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
818
819
820 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
821 is not contained in the font. */
822
823 static XCharStruct *
824 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
825 XFontStruct *font;
826 XChar2b *char2b;
827 int font_type; /* unused on X */
828 {
829 /* The result metric information. */
830 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
831
832 xassert (font && char2b);
833
834 if (font->per_char != NULL)
835 {
836 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
837 {
838 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
839 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
840 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
841 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
842 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
843 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
844 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
845 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
846 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
847 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
848 }
849 else
850 {
851 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
852 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
853 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
854 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
855
856 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
857 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
858
859 where:
860
861 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
862 / = integer division
863 \ = integer modulus */
864 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
865 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
866 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
867 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
868 {
869 pcm = (font->per_char
870 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
871 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
872 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
873 }
874 }
875 }
876 else
877 {
878 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
879 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
880 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
881 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
882 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
883 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
884 }
885
886 return ((pcm == NULL
887 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
888 ? NULL : pcm);
889 }
890
891
892 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
893 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
894
895 static int
896 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
897 int c;
898 XChar2b *char2b;
899 struct font_info *font_info;
900 int *two_byte_p;
901 {
902 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
903 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
904
905 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
906 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
907 fixed encoding. */
908 if (font_info->font_encoder)
909 {
910 /* It's a program. */
911 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
912
913 check_ccl_update (ccl);
914 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
915 {
916 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
917 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
918 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
919 }
920 else
921 {
922 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
923 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
924 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
925 }
926
927 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
928
929 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
930 program. */
931 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
932 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
933 else
934 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
935 }
936 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
937 {
938 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
939 encoding numbers. */
940 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
941
942 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
943 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
944 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
945
946 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
947 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
948 }
949
950 if (two_byte_p)
951 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
952
953 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
954 }
955
956
957 \f
958 /***********************************************************************
959 Glyph display
960 ***********************************************************************/
961
962
963
964 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
967 int));
968 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
972 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
973 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
974 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
977 unsigned long *, double, int));
978 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
979 double, int, unsigned long));
980 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
981 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
982 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
983 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
984 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
985 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
986 int, int, int));
987 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
988 int, int, int, int, int, int,
989 XRectangle *));
990 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
991 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
992
993 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
994 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
995 #endif
996
997
998 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
999 face. */
1000
1001 static void
1002 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1003 struct glyph_string *s;
1004 {
1005 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1006 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1007 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1008 && !s->cmp)
1009 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1010 else
1011 {
1012 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1013 XGCValues xgcv;
1014 unsigned long mask;
1015
1016 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1017 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1018
1019 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1020 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1021 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1022 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1023 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1024 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1025 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1026
1027 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1028 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1029 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1030 {
1031 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1032 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1033 }
1034
1035 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1036 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1037 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1038 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1039
1040 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1041 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1042 mask, &xgcv);
1043 else
1044 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1045 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1046
1047 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1048 }
1049 }
1050
1051
1052 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1056 struct glyph_string *s;
1057 {
1058 int face_id;
1059 struct face *face;
1060
1061 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1062 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1063 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1064 if (face == NULL)
1065 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1066
1067 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1068 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1069 else
1070 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1071 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1072 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1073
1074 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1075 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1076 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1077 else
1078 {
1079 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1080 but font FONT. */
1081 XGCValues xgcv;
1082 unsigned long mask;
1083
1084 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1085 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1086 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1087 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1088 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1089 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1090
1091 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1092 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1093 mask, &xgcv);
1094 else
1095 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1096 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1097
1098 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1099 }
1100
1101 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1102 }
1103
1104
1105 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1106 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1107 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1108
1109 static INLINE void
1110 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1111 struct glyph_string *s;
1112 {
1113 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1114 }
1115
1116
1117 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1118 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1119 pattern. */
1120
1121 static INLINE void
1122 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1123 struct glyph_string *s;
1124 {
1125 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1126
1127 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1128 {
1129 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1133 {
1134 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1136 }
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1138 {
1139 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = 0;
1141 }
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1143 {
1144 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1145 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1146 }
1147 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1148 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1149 {
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1152 }
1153 else
1154 {
1155 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1156 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1157 }
1158
1159 /* GC must have been set. */
1160 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1161 }
1162
1163
1164 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1165 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1166
1167 static INLINE void
1168 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1169 struct glyph_string *s;
1170 {
1171 XRectangle r;
1172 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1173 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1174 }
1175
1176
1177 /* RIF:
1178 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1179 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1180
1181 static void
1182 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1183 struct glyph_string *s;
1184 {
1185 if (s->cmp == NULL
1186 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1187 {
1188 XCharStruct cs;
1189 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1190 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1191 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1192 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1193 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1194 }
1195 }
1196
1197
1198 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1199
1200 static INLINE void
1201 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1202 struct glyph_string *s;
1203 int x, y, w, h;
1204 {
1205 XGCValues xgcv;
1206 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1207 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1208 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1209 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1210 }
1211
1212
1213 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1214 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1215 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1216 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1217 contains the first component of a composition. */
1218
1219 static void
1220 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1221 struct glyph_string *s;
1222 int force_p;
1223 {
1224 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1225 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1226 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1227 {
1228 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1229
1230 if (s->stippled_p)
1231 {
1232 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1234 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1235 s->y + box_line_width,
1236 s->background_width,
1237 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1238 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1239 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1240 }
1241 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1242 || s->font_not_found_p
1243 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1244 || force_p)
1245 {
1246 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1247 s->background_width,
1248 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1249 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 }
1253
1254
1255 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1256
1257 static void
1258 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1259 struct glyph_string *s;
1260 {
1261 int i, x;
1262
1263 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1264 of S to the right of that box line. */
1265 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1266 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1267 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1268 else
1269 x = s->x;
1270
1271 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1272 loaded. */
1273 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1274 {
1275 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1276 {
1277 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1278 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1279 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1280 s->height - 1);
1281 x += g->pixel_width;
1282 }
1283 }
1284 else
1285 {
1286 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1287 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1288
1289 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1290 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1291
1292 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1293 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1294 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1295 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1296
1297 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1298 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1299 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1300 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1301 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1302 if (s->for_overlaps
1303 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1304 {
1305 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1306 if (s->two_byte_p)
1307 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1308 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1309 else
1310 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1311 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1312 }
1313 else
1314 {
1315 if (s->two_byte_p)
1316 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1317 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1318 else
1319 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1320 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1321 }
1322
1323 if (s->face->overstrike)
1324 {
1325 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1326 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1327 if (s->two_byte_p)
1328 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1329 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1330 else
1331 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1332 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1333 }
1334 }
1335 }
1336
1337 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1338
1339 static void
1340 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1341 struct glyph_string *s;
1342 {
1343 int i, x;
1344
1345 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1346 of S to the right of that box line. */
1347 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1348 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1349 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1350 else
1351 x = s->x;
1352
1353 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1354 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1355 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1356 this composition. */
1357
1358 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1359 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1360 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1361 {
1362 if (s->gidx == 0)
1363 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1364 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1365 }
1366 else
1367 {
1368 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1369 {
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1374 if (s->face->overstrike)
1375 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1376 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1377 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1378 s->char2b + i, 1);
1379 }
1380 }
1381 }
1382
1383
1384 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1385
1386 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1387 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1388 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1389 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1390 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1391
1392
1393 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1394 cannot be determined. */
1395
1396 static struct frame *
1397 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1398 Widget widget;
1399 {
1400 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1401 Lisp_Object tail;
1402 struct frame *f;
1403
1404 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1405
1406 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1407 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1408 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1409 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1410 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1411 widget = XtParent (widget);
1412
1413 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1414 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1415 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1416 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1417 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1418 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1419 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1420 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1421 return f;
1422
1423 abort ();
1424 }
1425
1426
1427 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1428 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1429 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1430 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1431
1432 int
1433 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1434 Widget widget;
1435 Colormap cmap;
1436 XColor *color;
1437 {
1438 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1439 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1440 }
1441
1442
1443 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1444 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1445 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1446 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1447 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1448 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1449
1450 int
1451 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1452 Widget widget;
1453 Display *display;
1454 Colormap cmap;
1455 unsigned long *pixel;
1456 double factor;
1457 int delta;
1458 {
1459 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1460 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1461 }
1462
1463
1464 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1465 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1466
1467 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1468 {
1469 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1470 sizeof (Screen *)},
1471 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1472 sizeof (Colormap)}
1473 };
1474
1475
1476 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1477 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1478
1479 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1480
1481
1482 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1483
1484 DPY is the display we are working on.
1485
1486 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1487 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1488 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1489 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1490
1491 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1492 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1493
1494 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1495 we allocated the color or not.
1496
1497 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1498
1499 static Boolean
1500 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1501 Display *dpy;
1502 XrmValue *args;
1503 Cardinal *nargs;
1504 XrmValue *from, *to;
1505 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1506 {
1507 Screen *screen;
1508 Colormap cmap;
1509 Pixel pixel;
1510 String color_name;
1511 XColor color;
1512
1513 if (*nargs != 2)
1514 {
1515 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1516 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1517 "XtToolkitError",
1518 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1519 return False;
1520 }
1521
1522 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1523 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1524 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1525
1526 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1527 {
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1530 }
1531 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1532 {
1533 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1534 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1535 }
1536 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1537 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1538 {
1539 pixel = color.pixel;
1540 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1541 }
1542 else
1543 {
1544 String params[1];
1545 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1546
1547 params[0] = color_name;
1548 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1549 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1550 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1551 params, &nparams);
1552 return False;
1553 }
1554
1555 if (to->addr != NULL)
1556 {
1557 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1558 {
1559 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1560 return False;
1561 }
1562
1563 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1564 }
1565 else
1566 {
1567 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1568 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1569 }
1570
1571 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1572 return True;
1573 }
1574
1575
1576 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1577 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1578 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1579
1580 APP is the application context in which we work.
1581
1582 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1583 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1584 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1585
1586 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1587
1588 static void
1589 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1590 XtAppContext app;
1591 XrmValuePtr to;
1592 XtPointer closure;
1593 XrmValuePtr args;
1594 Cardinal *nargs;
1595 {
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1597 {
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1602 }
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1604 {
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1615
1616
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1621
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1624 Display *dpy;
1625 int *ncells;
1626 {
1627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1628
1629 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1630 {
1631 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1632 int i;
1633
1634 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1635 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells
1637 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1638 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1639
1640 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1642
1643 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1644 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1645 }
1646
1647 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1648 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1649 }
1650
1651
1652 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1653 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1654
1655 void
1656 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1657 struct frame *f;
1658 XColor *colors;
1659 int ncolors;
1660 {
1661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1662
1663 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1664 {
1665 int i;
1666 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1667 {
1668 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1669 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1670 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1671 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1672 }
1673 }
1674 else
1675 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1676 }
1677
1678
1679 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1680 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1681
1682 void
1683 x_query_color (f, color)
1684 struct frame *f;
1685 XColor *color;
1686 {
1687 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1688 }
1689
1690
1691 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1692 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1693 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1694 allocated. */
1695
1696 static int
1697 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1698 Display *dpy;
1699 Colormap cmap;
1700 XColor *color;
1701 {
1702 int rc;
1703
1704 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1705 if (rc == 0)
1706 {
1707 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1708 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1709 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1710 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1711 int nearest, i;
1712 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1713 int ncells;
1714 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1715
1716 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1717 {
1718 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1719 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1720 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1721 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1722
1723 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1724 {
1725 nearest = i;
1726 nearest_delta = delta;
1727 }
1728 }
1729
1730 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1731 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1732 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1733 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1734 }
1735 else
1736 {
1737 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1738 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1739 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1740 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1741 XColor *cached_color;
1742
1743 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1744 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1745 (cached_color->red != color->red
1746 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1747 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1748 {
1749 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1750 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1751 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1752 }
1753 }
1754
1755 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1756 if (rc)
1757 register_color (color->pixel);
1758 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1759
1760 return rc;
1761 }
1762
1763
1764 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1765 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1766 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1767 allocated. */
1768
1769 int
1770 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1771 struct frame *f;
1772 Colormap cmap;
1773 XColor *color;
1774 {
1775 gamma_correct (f, color);
1776 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1777 }
1778
1779
1780 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1781 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1782 get color reference counts right. */
1783
1784 unsigned long
1785 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1786 struct frame *f;
1787 unsigned long pixel;
1788 {
1789 XColor color;
1790
1791 color.pixel = pixel;
1792 BLOCK_INPUT;
1793 x_query_color (f, &color);
1794 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1795 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1796 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1797 register_color (pixel);
1798 #endif
1799 return color.pixel;
1800 }
1801
1802
1803 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1804 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1805 get color reference counts right. */
1806
1807 unsigned long
1808 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1809 Display *dpy;
1810 Colormap cmap;
1811 unsigned long pixel;
1812 {
1813 XColor color;
1814
1815 color.pixel = pixel;
1816 BLOCK_INPUT;
1817 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1818 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1819 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1820 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1821 register_color (pixel);
1822 #endif
1823 return color.pixel;
1824 }
1825
1826
1827 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1828 boosted.
1829
1830 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1831 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1832 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1833 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1834 use an additional additive factor.
1835
1836 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1837 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1838 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1839
1840
1841 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1842 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1843 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1844 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1845 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1846 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1847
1848 static int
1849 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1850 struct frame *f;
1851 Display *display;
1852 Colormap cmap;
1853 unsigned long *pixel;
1854 double factor;
1855 int delta;
1856 {
1857 XColor color, new;
1858 long bright;
1859 int success_p;
1860
1861 /* Get RGB color values. */
1862 color.pixel = *pixel;
1863 x_query_color (f, &color);
1864
1865 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1866 xassert (factor >= 0);
1867 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1868 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1869 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1870
1871 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1872 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1873
1874 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1875 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1876 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1877 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1878 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1879 {
1880 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1881 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1882 /* The additive adjustment. */
1883 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1884
1885 if (factor < 1)
1886 {
1887 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1888 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1889 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1890 }
1891 else
1892 {
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1896 }
1897 }
1898
1899 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1900 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1901 if (success_p)
1902 {
1903 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1904 {
1905 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1906 delta to the RGB values. */
1907 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1908
1909 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1910 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1911 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1912 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1913 }
1914 else
1915 success_p = 1;
1916 *pixel = new.pixel;
1917 }
1918
1919 return success_p;
1920 }
1921
1922
1923 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1924 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1925 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1926 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1927 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1928 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1929
1930 static void
1931 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1932 struct frame *f;
1933 struct relief *relief;
1934 double factor;
1935 int delta;
1936 unsigned long default_pixel;
1937 {
1938 XGCValues xgcv;
1939 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1940 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1941 unsigned long pixel;
1942 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1943 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1944 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1945 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1946
1947 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1948 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1949
1950 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1951 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1952 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1953 if (relief->gc
1954 && relief->allocated_p)
1955 {
1956 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1957 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Allocate new color. */
1961 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1962 pixel = background;
1963 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1964 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1965 {
1966 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1967 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1968 }
1969
1970 if (relief->gc == 0)
1971 {
1972 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1973 mask |= GCStipple;
1974 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1975 }
1976 else
1977 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1978 }
1979
1980
1981 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1982
1983 static void
1984 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1985 struct glyph_string *s;
1986 {
1987 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1988 unsigned long color;
1989
1990 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1991 color = s->face->box_color;
1992 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1993 && s->img->pixmap
1994 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1995 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1996 else
1997 {
1998 XGCValues xgcv;
1999
2000 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2001 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2002 color = xgcv.background;
2003 }
2004
2005 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2006 || color != di->relief_background)
2007 {
2008 di->relief_background = color;
2009 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2010 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2011 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2012 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2013 }
2014 }
2015
2016
2017 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2018 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2019 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2020 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2021 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2022 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2023 when drawing. */
2024
2025 static void
2026 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2027 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2028 struct frame *f;
2029 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2030 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2031 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2032 {
2033 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2034 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2035 int i;
2036 GC gc;
2037
2038 if (raised_p)
2039 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2040 else
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2043
2044 /* Top. */
2045 if (top_p)
2046 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2047 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2048 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2049 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2050
2051 /* Left. */
2052 if (left_p)
2053 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2054 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2055 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2056
2057 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2058 if (raised_p)
2059 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2060 else
2061 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2062 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2063
2064 /* Bottom. */
2065 if (bot_p)
2066 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2069 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2070
2071 /* Right. */
2072 if (right_p)
2073 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2074 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2075 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2076
2077 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2078 }
2079
2080
2081 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2082 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2083 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2084 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2085 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2086 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2087
2088 static void
2089 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2090 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2091 struct glyph_string *s;
2092 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2093 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2094 {
2095 XGCValues xgcv;
2096
2097 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2098 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2099 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2100
2101 /* Top. */
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2104
2105 /* Left. */
2106 if (left_p)
2107 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2108 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2109
2110 /* Bottom. */
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2113
2114 /* Right. */
2115 if (right_p)
2116 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2117 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2118
2119 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2120 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2121 }
2122
2123
2124 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2125
2126 static void
2127 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2128 struct glyph_string *s;
2129 {
2130 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2131 int left_p, right_p;
2132 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2133 XRectangle clip_rect;
2134
2135 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2136 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2137 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2138
2139 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2140 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2141 ? s->first_glyph
2142 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2143
2144 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2145 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2146 left_x = s->x;
2147 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2148 ? last_x - 1
2149 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2150 top_y = s->y;
2151 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2152
2153 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2154 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2155 && (s->prev == NULL
2156 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2157 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2158 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2159 && (s->next == NULL
2160 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2161
2162 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2163
2164 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2165 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2166 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2167 else
2168 {
2169 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2170 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2171 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2172 }
2173 }
2174
2175
2176 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2177
2178 static void
2179 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2180 struct glyph_string *s;
2181 {
2182 int x = s->x;
2183 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2184
2185 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2186 right of that line. */
2187 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2188 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2189 && s->slice.x == 0)
2190 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2191
2192 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2193 by that margin. */
2194 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2195 x += s->img->hmargin;
2196 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2197 y += s->img->vmargin;
2198
2199 if (s->img->pixmap)
2200 {
2201 if (s->img->mask)
2202 {
2203 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2204 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2205 trust on the shape extension to be available
2206 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2207 manually. */
2208 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2209 | GCFunction);
2210 XGCValues xgcv;
2211 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2212
2213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2218
2219 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2220 image_rect.x = x;
2221 image_rect.y = y;
2222 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2223 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2224 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2226 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2227 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2228 }
2229 else
2230 {
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2232
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2242
2243 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2244 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2245 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2246 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2247 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2248 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2249 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2250 {
2251 int r = s->img->relief;
2252 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2253 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2254 x - r, y - r,
2255 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2256 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2257 }
2258 }
2259 }
2260 else
2261 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2263 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2264 }
2265
2266
2267 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2268
2269 static void
2270 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2271 struct glyph_string *s;
2272 {
2273 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2274 XRectangle r;
2275 int x = s->x;
2276 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2277
2278 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2279 right of that line. */
2280 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2281 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2282 && s->slice.x == 0)
2283 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2284
2285 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2286 by that margin. */
2287 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2288 x += s->img->hmargin;
2289 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2290 y += s->img->vmargin;
2291
2292 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2293 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2294 {
2295 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2296 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2297 }
2298 else
2299 {
2300 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2301 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2302 }
2303
2304 x0 = x - thick;
2305 y0 = y - thick;
2306 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2307 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2308
2309 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2310 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2311 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2312 s->slice.y == 0,
2313 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2314 s->slice.x == 0,
2315 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2316 &r);
2317 }
2318
2319
2320 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2321
2322 static void
2323 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2324 struct glyph_string *s;
2325 Pixmap pixmap;
2326 {
2327 int x = 0;
2328 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2329
2330 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2331 right of that line. */
2332 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2333 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2334 && s->slice.x == 0)
2335 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2336
2337 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2338 by that margin. */
2339 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2340 x += s->img->hmargin;
2341 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2342 y += s->img->vmargin;
2343
2344 if (s->img->pixmap)
2345 {
2346 if (s->img->mask)
2347 {
2348 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2349 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2350 trust on the shape extension to be available
2351 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2352 manually. */
2353 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2354 | GCFunction);
2355 XGCValues xgcv;
2356
2357 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2358 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2359 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2360 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2361 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2362
2363 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2364 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2365 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2366 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2367 }
2368 else
2369 {
2370 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2371 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2372 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2373
2374 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2375 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2376 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2377 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2378 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2379 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2380 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2381 {
2382 int r = s->img->relief;
2383 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2384 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2385 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2386 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2387 }
2388 }
2389 }
2390 else
2391 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2392 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2393 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2394 }
2395
2396
2397 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2398 give the rectangle to draw. */
2399
2400 static void
2401 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2402 struct glyph_string *s;
2403 int x, y, w, h;
2404 {
2405 if (s->stippled_p)
2406 {
2407 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2408 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2409 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2410 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2411 }
2412 else
2413 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2414 }
2415
2416
2417 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2418
2419 s->y
2420 s->x +-------------------------
2421 | s->face->box
2422 |
2423 | +-------------------------
2424 | | s->img->margin
2425 | |
2426 | | +-------------------
2427 | | | the image
2428
2429 */
2430
2431 static void
2432 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2433 struct glyph_string *s;
2434 {
2435 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2436 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2437 int height;
2438 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2439
2440 height = s->height;
2441 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2442 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2443 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2444 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2445
2446 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2447 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2448 flickering. */
2449 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2450 if (height > s->slice.height
2451 || s->img->hmargin
2452 || s->img->vmargin
2453 || s->img->mask
2454 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2455 || s->width != s->background_width)
2456 {
2457 if (s->img->mask)
2458 {
2459 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2460 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2461 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2462 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2463 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2464
2465 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2466 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2467 s->background_width,
2468 s->height, depth);
2469
2470 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2471 pixmap. */
2472 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2473
2474 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2475 if (s->stippled_p)
2476 {
2477 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2478 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2479 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2480 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2481 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2482 }
2483 else
2484 {
2485 XGCValues xgcv;
2486 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2487 &xgcv);
2488 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2489 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2490 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2491 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2492 }
2493 }
2494 else
2495 {
2496 int x = s->x;
2497 int y = s->y;
2498
2499 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2500 && s->slice.x == 0)
2501 x += box_line_hwidth;
2502
2503 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2504 y += box_line_vwidth;
2505
2506 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2507 }
2508
2509 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2510 }
2511
2512 /* Draw the foreground. */
2513 if (pixmap != None)
2514 {
2515 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2516 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2517 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2518 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2519 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2520 }
2521 else
2522 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2523
2524 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2525 if (s->img->relief
2526 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2528 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2529 }
2530
2531
2532 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2533
2534 static void
2535 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2536 struct glyph_string *s;
2537 {
2538 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2539 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2540
2541 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2542 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2543 {
2544 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2545 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2546 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2547
2548 /* Draw cursor. */
2549 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2550
2551 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2552 if (width < s->background_width)
2553 {
2554 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2555 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2556 XRectangle r;
2557 GC gc;
2558
2559 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2560 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2561 {
2562 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2563 gc = s->gc;
2564 }
2565 else
2566 gc = s->face->gc;
2567
2568 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2569 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2570
2571 if (s->face->stipple)
2572 {
2573 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2574 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2575 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2576 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2577 }
2578 else
2579 {
2580 XGCValues xgcv;
2581 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2582 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2583 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2584 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2585 }
2586 }
2587 }
2588 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2589 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2590 s->height);
2591
2592 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2593 }
2594
2595
2596 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2597
2598 static void
2599 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2600 struct glyph_string *s;
2601 {
2602 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2603
2604 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2605 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2606 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2607 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2608 {
2609 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2610 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2612 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2613 }
2614
2615 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2616 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2617
2618 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2619 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2620 if (!s->for_overlaps
2621 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2622 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2623 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2624
2625 {
2626 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2627 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2629 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2630 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2631 }
2632 else
2633 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2634
2635 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2636 {
2637 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2638 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2639 break;
2640
2641 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2642 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2643 break;
2644
2645 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2646 if (s->for_overlaps)
2647 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2648 else
2649 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2651 break;
2652
2653 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2654 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2655 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2656 else
2657 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2658 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2659 break;
2660
2661 default:
2662 abort ();
2663 }
2664
2665 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2666 {
2667 /* Draw underline. */
2668 if (s->face->underline_p)
2669 {
2670 unsigned long tem, h;
2671 int y;
2672
2673 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2674 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2675 h = 1;
2676
2677 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2678 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2679 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2680 specs, and its default is
2681
2682 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2683 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2684
2685 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2686 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2687 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2688 else if (s->face->font)
2689 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2690 else
2691 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2692
2693 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2694 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2695 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2696 else
2697 {
2698 XGCValues xgcv;
2699 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2700 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2701 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2702 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2703 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2704 }
2705 }
2706
2707 /* Draw overline. */
2708 if (s->face->overline_p)
2709 {
2710 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2711
2712 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2713 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2714 s->width, h);
2715 else
2716 {
2717 XGCValues xgcv;
2718 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2719 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2720 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2721 s->width, h);
2722 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2723 }
2724 }
2725
2726 /* Draw strike-through. */
2727 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2728 {
2729 unsigned long h = 1;
2730 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2731
2732 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2733 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2734 s->width, h);
2735 else
2736 {
2737 XGCValues xgcv;
2738 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2739 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2740 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2741 s->width, h);
2742 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2743 }
2744 }
2745
2746 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2747 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2748 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2749 }
2750
2751 /* Reset clipping. */
2752 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2753 }
2754
2755 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2756
2757 void
2758 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2759 struct frame *f;
2760 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2761 {
2762 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2763 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2764 x, y, width, height,
2765 x + shift_by, y);
2766 }
2767
2768 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2769 for X frames. */
2770
2771 static void
2772 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2773 register int n;
2774 {
2775 abort ();
2776 }
2777
2778
2779 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2780 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2781
2782 void
2783 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2784 Display *dpy;
2785 Window window;
2786 int x, y;
2787 int width, height;
2788 int exposures;
2789 {
2790 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2791 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2792 }
2793
2794
2795 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2796 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2797
2798 static void
2799 x_clear_frame ()
2800 {
2801 struct frame *f;
2802
2803 if (updating_frame)
2804 f = updating_frame;
2805 else
2806 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2807
2808 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2809 longer visible. */
2810 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2811 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2812 output_cursor.x = -1;
2813
2814 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2815 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2816 BLOCK_INPUT;
2817 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2818
2819 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2820 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2821 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2822
2823 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2824
2825 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2826 }
2827
2828
2829 \f
2830 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2831
2832 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2833 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2834
2835 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2836
2837
2838 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2839 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2840
2841 static int
2842 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2843 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2844 {
2845 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2846 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2847 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2848 {
2849 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2850 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2851 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2852 }
2853
2854 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2855 {
2856 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2857 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2858 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2859 }
2860
2861 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2862 positive. */
2863 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2864 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2865
2866 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2867 negative. */
2868 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2869 }
2870
2871 void
2872 XTflash (f)
2873 struct frame *f;
2874 {
2875 BLOCK_INPUT;
2876
2877 {
2878 GC gc;
2879
2880 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2881 pixels into background pixels. */
2882 {
2883 XGCValues values;
2884
2885 values.function = GXxor;
2886 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2887 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2888
2889 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2890 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2891 }
2892
2893 {
2894 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2895 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2896 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2897 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2898 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2899 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2900 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901
2902 int width;
2903
2904 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2905 edge it is next to. */
2906 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2907 {
2908 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2909 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2910 break;
2911
2912 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2913 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2914 break;
2915
2916 default:
2917 break;
2918 }
2919
2920 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2921
2922 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2923 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2924 {
2925 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2926 flash_left,
2927 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2928 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2929 width, flash_height);
2930 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2931 flash_left,
2932 (height - flash_height
2933 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2934 width, flash_height);
2935 }
2936 else
2937 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2938 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2939 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2940 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2941
2942 x_flush (f);
2943
2944 {
2945 struct timeval wakeup;
2946
2947 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2948
2949 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2950 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2951 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2952 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2953
2954 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2955 available. */
2956 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2957 {
2958 struct timeval current;
2959 struct timeval timeout;
2960
2961 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2962
2963 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2964 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2965 break;
2966
2967 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2968 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2969 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2970
2971 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2972 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2973 }
2974 }
2975
2976 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2977 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2978 {
2979 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2980 flash_left,
2981 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2982 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2983 width, flash_height);
2984 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2985 flash_left,
2986 (height - flash_height
2987 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2988 width, flash_height);
2989 }
2990 else
2991 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2992 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2993 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2994 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2995
2996 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2997 x_flush (f);
2998 }
2999 }
3000
3001 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3002 }
3003
3004 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3005
3006
3007 /* Make audible bell. */
3008
3009 void
3010 XTring_bell ()
3011 {
3012 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3013
3014 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3015 {
3016 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3017 if (visible_bell)
3018 XTflash (f);
3019 else
3020 #endif
3021 {
3022 BLOCK_INPUT;
3023 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3024 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3025 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3026 }
3027 }
3028 }
3029
3030 \f
3031 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3032 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3033 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3034 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3035
3036 static void
3037 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3038 register int n;
3039 {
3040 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3041 }
3042
3043
3044 \f
3045 /***********************************************************************
3046 Line Dance
3047 ***********************************************************************/
3048
3049 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3050 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3051
3052 static void
3053 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3054 int vpos, n;
3055 {
3056 abort ();
3057 }
3058
3059
3060 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3061
3062 static void
3063 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3064 struct window *w;
3065 struct run *run;
3066 {
3067 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3068 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3069
3070 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3071 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3072 fringe of W. */
3073 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3074
3075 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3076 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3077 bottom_y = y + height;
3078
3079 if (to_y < from_y)
3080 {
3081 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3082 line at the bottom. */
3083 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3084 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3085 else
3086 height = run->height;
3087 }
3088 else
3089 {
3090 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3091 at the bottom. */
3092 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3093 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3094 else
3095 height = run->height;
3096 }
3097
3098 BLOCK_INPUT;
3099
3100 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3101 updated_window = w;
3102 x_clear_cursor (w);
3103
3104 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3105 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3106 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3107 x, from_y,
3108 width, height,
3109 x, to_y);
3110
3111 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3112 }
3113
3114
3115 \f
3116 /***********************************************************************
3117 Exposure Events
3118 ***********************************************************************/
3119
3120 \f
3121 static void
3122 frame_highlight (f)
3123 struct frame *f;
3124 {
3125 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3126 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3127 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3128 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3129 BLOCK_INPUT;
3130 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3131 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3132 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3133 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3134 }
3135
3136 static void
3137 frame_unhighlight (f)
3138 struct frame *f;
3139 {
3140 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3141 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3142 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3143 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3144 BLOCK_INPUT;
3145 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3146 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3148 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3149 }
3150
3151 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3152 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3153 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3154 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3155 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3156
3157 static void
3158 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3159 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3160 struct frame *frame;
3161 {
3162 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3163
3164 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3165 {
3166 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3167 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3168 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3169
3170 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3171 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3172
3173 #if 0
3174 selected_frame = frame;
3175 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3176 selected_frame);
3177 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3178 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3179 #endif /* ! 0 */
3180
3181 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3182 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3183 else
3184 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3185 }
3186
3187 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3188 }
3189
3190 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3191 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3192 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3193
3194 static void
3195 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3196 int type;
3197 int state;
3198 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3199 struct frame *frame;
3200 struct input_event *bufp;
3201 {
3202 if (type == FocusIn)
3203 {
3204 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3205 {
3206 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3207 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3208
3209 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3210 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3211 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3212 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3213 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3214 {
3215 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3216 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3217 }
3218 }
3219
3220 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3221
3222 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3223 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3224 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3225 #endif
3226 }
3227 else if (type == FocusOut)
3228 {
3229 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3230
3231 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3232 {
3233 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3234 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3235 }
3236
3237 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3238 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3239 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3240 #endif
3241 }
3242 }
3243
3244 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3245 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3246
3247 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3248
3249 static void
3250 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3251 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3252 XEvent *event;
3253 struct input_event *bufp;
3254 {
3255 struct frame *frame;
3256
3257 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3258 if (! frame)
3259 return;
3260
3261 switch (event->type)
3262 {
3263 case EnterNotify:
3264 case LeaveNotify:
3265 {
3266 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3267 int focus_state
3268 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3269
3270 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3271 && event->xcrossing.focus
3272 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3273 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3274 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3275 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3276 }
3277 break;
3278
3279 case FocusIn:
3280 case FocusOut:
3281 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3282 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3283 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3284 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3285 break;
3286 }
3287 }
3288
3289
3290 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3291
3292 void
3293 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3294 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3295 {
3296 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3297 }
3298
3299 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3300 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3301 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3302
3303 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3304 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3305 the appropriate X display info. */
3306
3307 static void
3308 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3309 struct frame *frame;
3310 {
3311 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3312 }
3313
3314 static void
3315 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3316 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3317 {
3318 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3319
3320 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3321 {
3322 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3323 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3324 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3325 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3326 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3327 {
3328 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3329 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3330 }
3331 }
3332 else
3333 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3334
3335 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3336 {
3337 if (old_highlight)
3338 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3339 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3340 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3341 }
3342 }
3343
3344
3345 \f
3346 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3347
3348 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3349 static void
3350 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3351 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3352 {
3353 int min_code, max_code;
3354 KeySym *syms;
3355 int syms_per_code;
3356 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3357
3358 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3359 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3363
3364 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3365 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3366 #else
3367 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3368 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3369 #endif
3370
3371 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3372 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3373 &syms_per_code);
3374 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3375
3376 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3377 Alt keysyms are on. */
3378 {
3379 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3380 int found_alt_or_meta;
3381
3382 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3383 {
3384 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3385 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3386 {
3387 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3388
3389 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3390 if (code == 0)
3391 continue;
3392
3393 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3394 {
3395 int code_col;
3396
3397 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3398 {
3399 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3400
3401 switch (sym)
3402 {
3403 case XK_Meta_L:
3404 case XK_Meta_R:
3405 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3406 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3407 break;
3408
3409 case XK_Alt_L:
3410 case XK_Alt_R:
3411 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3412 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3413 break;
3414
3415 case XK_Hyper_L:
3416 case XK_Hyper_R:
3417 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3418 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3419 code_col = syms_per_code;
3420 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3421 break;
3422
3423 case XK_Super_L:
3424 case XK_Super_R:
3425 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3426 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3427 code_col = syms_per_code;
3428 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3429 break;
3430
3431 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3432 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3433 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3434 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3435 code_col = syms_per_code;
3436 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3437 break;
3438 }
3439 }
3440 }
3441 }
3442 }
3443 }
3444
3445 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3446 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3447 {
3448 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3449 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3450 }
3451
3452 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3453 make them just meta, not alt. */
3454 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3455 {
3456 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3457 }
3458
3459 XFree ((char *) syms);
3460 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3461 }
3462
3463 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3464 Emacs uses. */
3465
3466 unsigned int
3467 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3468 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3469 unsigned int state;
3470 {
3471 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3475 Lisp_Object tem;
3476
3477 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3478 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3479 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3480 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3481 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3482 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3483 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3484 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3485
3486
3487 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3488 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3493 }
3494
3495 static unsigned int
3496 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3497 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3498 unsigned int state;
3499 {
3500 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3504
3505 Lisp_Object tem;
3506
3507 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3508 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3509 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3510 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3511 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3512 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3513 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3514 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3515
3516
3517 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3518 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3521 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3523 }
3524
3525 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3526
3527 char *
3528 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3529 KeySym keysym;
3530 {
3531 char *value;
3532
3533 BLOCK_INPUT;
3534 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3535 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3536
3537 return value;
3538 }
3539
3540
3541 \f
3542 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3543
3544 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3545
3546 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3547 the mouse. */
3548
3549 static Lisp_Object
3550 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3551 struct input_event *result;
3552 XButtonEvent *event;
3553 struct frame *f;
3554 {
3555 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3556 otherwise. */
3557 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3558 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3559 result->timestamp = event->time;
3560 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3561 event->state)
3562 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3563 ? up_modifier
3564 : down_modifier));
3565
3566 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3567 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3568 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3569 result->arg = Qnil;
3570 return Qnil;
3571 }
3572
3573 \f
3574 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3575 The input handler calls this.
3576
3577 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3578 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3579 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3580 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3581
3582 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3583 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3584
3585 static int
3586 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3587 FRAME_PTR frame;
3588 XMotionEvent *event;
3589 {
3590 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3591 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3592 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3593
3594 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3595 return 0;
3596
3597 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3598 {
3599 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3600 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3601 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3602 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3603 return 1;
3604 }
3605
3606
3607 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3608 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3609 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3610 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3611 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3612 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3613 {
3614 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3615 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3616 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3617 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3618 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3619 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3620 return 1;
3621 }
3622
3623 return 0;
3624 }
3625
3626 \f
3627 /************************************************************************
3628 Mouse Face
3629 ************************************************************************/
3630
3631 static void
3632 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3633 {
3634 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3635 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3636 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3637 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3638 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3639 }
3640
3641
3642
3643 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3644 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3645
3646 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3647 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3648 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3649 position on the scroll bar.
3650
3651 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3652 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3653 the mouse is over.
3654
3655 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3656 was at this position.
3657
3658 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3659
3660 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3661 movement. */
3662
3663 static void
3664 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3665 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3666 int insist;
3667 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3668 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3669 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3670 unsigned long *time;
3671 {
3672 FRAME_PTR f1;
3673
3674 BLOCK_INPUT;
3675
3676 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3677 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3678 else
3679 {
3680 Window root;
3681 int root_x, root_y;
3682
3683 Window dummy_window;
3684 int dummy;
3685
3686 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3687
3688 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3689 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3690 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3691 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3692
3693 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3694
3695 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3696 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3697 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3698
3699 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3700 &root,
3701
3702 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3703 a different screen. */
3704 &dummy_window,
3705
3706 /* The position on that root window. */
3707 &root_x, &root_y,
3708
3709 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3710 &dummy, &dummy,
3711
3712 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3713 we don't care. */
3714 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3715
3716 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3717 containing the pointer. */
3718 {
3719 Window win, child;
3720 int win_x, win_y;
3721 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3722
3723 win = root;
3724
3725 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3726 structure is changing at the same time this function
3727 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3728
3729 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3730
3731 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3732 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3733 {
3734 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3735 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3736 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3737
3738 /* From-window, to-window. */
3739 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3740
3741 /* From-position, to-position. */
3742 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3743
3744 /* Child of win. */
3745 &child);
3746 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3747 }
3748 else
3749 {
3750 while (1)
3751 {
3752 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3753
3754 /* From-window, to-window. */
3755 root, win,
3756
3757 /* From-position, to-position. */
3758 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3759
3760 /* Child of win. */
3761 &child);
3762
3763 if (child == None || child == win)
3764 break;
3765
3766 win = child;
3767 parent_x = win_x;
3768 parent_y = win_y;
3769 }
3770
3771 /* Now we know that:
3772 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3773 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3774 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3775 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3776 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3777 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3778 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3779 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3780 never use them in that case.) */
3781
3782 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3783 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3784
3785 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3786 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3787 on the frame. */
3788 if (f1 != NULL
3789 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3790 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3791 f1 = NULL;
3792 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3793 }
3794
3795 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3796 f1 = 0;
3797
3798 x_uncatch_errors ();
3799
3800 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3801 if (! f1)
3802 {
3803 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3804
3805 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3806
3807 if (bar)
3808 {
3809 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3810 win_x = parent_x;
3811 win_y = parent_y;
3812 }
3813 }
3814
3815 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3816 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3817
3818 if (f1)
3819 {
3820 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3821 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3822 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3823 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3824 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3825 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3826 the frame are divided into. */
3827
3828 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3829 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3830
3831 *bar_window = Qnil;
3832 *part = 0;
3833 *fp = f1;
3834 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3835 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3836 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3837 }
3838 }
3839 }
3840
3841 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3842 }
3843
3844
3845 \f
3846 /***********************************************************************
3847 Scroll bars
3848 ***********************************************************************/
3849
3850 /* Scroll bar support. */
3851
3852 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3853 manages it.
3854 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3855 bits. */
3856
3857 static struct scroll_bar *
3858 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3859 Display *display;
3860 Window window_id;
3861 {
3862 Lisp_Object tail;
3863
3864 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3865 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3866 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3867
3868 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3869 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3870 tail = XCDR (tail))
3871 {
3872 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3873
3874 frame = XCAR (tail);
3875 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3876 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3877 abort ();
3878
3879 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3880 right window ID. */
3881 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3882 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3883 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3884 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3885 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3886 condemned = Qnil,
3887 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3888 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3889 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3890 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3891 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3892 }
3893
3894 return 0;
3895 }
3896
3897
3898 #if defined USE_LUCID
3899
3900 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3901 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3902
3903 static Widget
3904 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3905 Window window;
3906 {
3907 Lisp_Object tail;
3908
3909 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3910 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3911 tail = XCDR (tail))
3912 {
3913 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3914 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3915
3916 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3917 return menu_bar;
3918 }
3919
3920 return NULL;
3921 }
3922
3923 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3924
3925 \f
3926 /************************************************************************
3927 Toolkit scroll bars
3928 ************************************************************************/
3929
3930 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3931
3932 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3933 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3934 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3935 struct scroll_bar *));
3936 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3937 int, int, int));
3938
3939
3940 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3941 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3942
3943 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3944
3945 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3946
3947 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3948
3949 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3950 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3951
3952 #ifndef USE_GTK
3953 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3954
3955 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3956
3957 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3958
3959 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3960 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3961 to avoid jerkyness. */
3962
3963 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3964
3965 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3966 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3967 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3968 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3969
3970 static void
3971 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3972 num_params)
3973 Widget widget;
3974 XtPointer client_data;
3975 String action_name;
3976 XEvent *event;
3977 String *params;
3978 Cardinal *num_params;
3979 {
3980 int scroll_bar_p;
3981 char *end_action;
3982
3983 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
3984 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
3985 end_action = "Release";
3986 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
3987 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
3988 end_action = "EndScroll";
3989 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
3990
3991 if (scroll_bar_p
3992 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
3993 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
3994 {
3995 struct window *w;
3996
3997 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
3998 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
3999 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4000
4001 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4002 {
4003 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4004 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4005 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4006 }
4007 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4008 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4009
4010 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4011 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4012 }
4013 }
4014 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4015
4016 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4017 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4018
4019 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4020 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4021
4022
4023 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4024 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4025 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4026 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4027
4028 static void
4029 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4030 Lisp_Object window;
4031 int part, portion, whole;
4032 {
4033 XEvent event;
4034 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4035 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4036 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4037 int i;
4038
4039 BLOCK_INPUT;
4040
4041 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4042 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4043 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4044 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4045 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4046 ev->format = 32;
4047
4048 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4049 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4050 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4051 into that array in the event. */
4052 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4053 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4054 break;
4055
4056 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4057 {
4058 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4059 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4060 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4061
4062 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4063 nbytes);
4064 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4065 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4066 }
4067
4068 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4069 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4070 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4071 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4072 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4073 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4074
4075 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4076 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4077
4078 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4079 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4080 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4081 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4082 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4083 }
4084
4085
4086 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4087 in *IEVENT. */
4088
4089 static void
4090 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4091 XEvent *event;
4092 struct input_event *ievent;
4093 {
4094 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4095 Lisp_Object window;
4096 struct frame *f;
4097 struct window *w;
4098
4099 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4100 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4101
4102 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4103 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4104
4105 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4106 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4107 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4108 #ifdef USE_GTK
4109 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4110 #else
4111 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4112 #endif
4113 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4114 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4115 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4116 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4117 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4118 }
4119
4120
4121 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4122
4123 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4124
4125 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4126
4127
4128 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4129 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4130 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4131
4132 static void
4133 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4134 Widget widget;
4135 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4136 {
4137 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4138 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4139 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4140
4141 switch (cs->reason)
4142 {
4143 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4144 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4145 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4146 break;
4147
4148 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4149 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4150 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4151 break;
4152
4153 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4154 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4155 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4156 break;
4157
4158 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4159 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4160 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4161 break;
4162
4163 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4164 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4165 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4166 break;
4167
4168 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4169 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4170 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4171 break;
4172
4173 case XmCR_DRAG:
4174 {
4175 int slider_size;
4176
4177 /* Get the slider size. */
4178 BLOCK_INPUT;
4179 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4180 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4181
4182 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4183 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4184 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4185 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4186 }
4187 break;
4188
4189 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4190 break;
4191 };
4192
4193 if (part >= 0)
4194 {
4195 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4196 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4197 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4198 }
4199 }
4200
4201
4202 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4203 #ifdef USE_GTK
4204 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4205 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4206
4207 static void
4208 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4209 GtkRange *widget;
4210 gpointer data;
4211 {
4212 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4213 gdouble previous;
4214 gdouble position;
4215 gdouble *p;
4216 int diff;
4217
4218 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4219 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4220
4221 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4222
4223 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4224 if (! p)
4225 {
4226 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4227 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4228 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4229 }
4230
4231 previous = *p;
4232 *p = position;
4233
4234 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4235
4236 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4237
4238 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4239 {
4240 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4241 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4242 }
4243 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4244 {
4245 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4246 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4247 }
4248 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4249 {
4250 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4251 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4252 }
4253 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4254 {
4255 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4256 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4257 }
4258 else
4259 {
4260 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4261 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4262 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4263 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4264 }
4265
4266 if (part >= 0)
4267 {
4268 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4269 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4270 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4271 }
4272 }
4273
4274 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4275
4276 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4277 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4278 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4279 the thumb is. */
4280
4281 static void
4282 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4283 Widget widget;
4284 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4285 {
4286 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4287 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4288 float shown;
4289 int whole, portion, height;
4290 int part;
4291
4292 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4293 BLOCK_INPUT;
4294 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4295 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4296
4297 whole = 10000000;
4298 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4299
4300 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4301 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4302 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4303 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4304 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4305 bottom). */
4306 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4307 else
4308 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4309
4310 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4311 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4312 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4313 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4314 }
4315
4316
4317 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4318 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4319 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4320 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4321 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4322 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4323 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4324
4325 static void
4326 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4327 Widget widget;
4328 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4329 {
4330 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4331 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4332 int position = (long) call_data;
4333 Dimension height;
4334 int part;
4335
4336 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4337 BLOCK_INPUT;
4338 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4339 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4340
4341 if (abs (position) >= height)
4342 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4343
4344 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4345 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4346 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4347 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4348 else
4349 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4350
4351 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4352 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4353 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4354 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4355 }
4356
4357 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4358 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4359
4360 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4361
4362 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4363 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4364
4365 #ifdef USE_GTK
4366 static void
4367 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4368 struct frame *f;
4369 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4370 {
4371 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4372
4373 BLOCK_INPUT;
4374 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4375 scroll_bar_name);
4376 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4377 }
4378
4379 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4380
4381 static void
4382 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4383 struct frame *f;
4384 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4385 {
4386 Window xwindow;
4387 Widget widget;
4388 Arg av[20];
4389 int ac = 0;
4390 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4391 unsigned long pixel;
4392
4393 BLOCK_INPUT;
4394
4395 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4396 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4397 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4398 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4399 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4400 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4401 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4402 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4403 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4404
4405 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4406 if (pixel != -1)
4407 {
4408 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4409 ++ac;
4410 }
4411
4412 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4413 if (pixel != -1)
4414 {
4415 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4416 ++ac;
4417 }
4418
4419 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4420 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4421
4422 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4423 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4424 (XtPointer) bar);
4425 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4426 (XtPointer) bar);
4427 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4428 (XtPointer) bar);
4429 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4430 (XtPointer) bar);
4431 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4432 (XtPointer) bar);
4433 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4434 (XtPointer) bar);
4435 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4436 (XtPointer) bar);
4437
4438 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4439 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4440
4441 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4442 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4443 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4444 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4445
4446 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4447
4448 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4449 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4450 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4451 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4452 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4453 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4454 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4455 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4456
4457 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4458 if (pixel != -1)
4459 {
4460 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4461 ++ac;
4462 }
4463
4464 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4465 if (pixel != -1)
4466 {
4467 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4468 ++ac;
4469 }
4470
4471 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4472
4473 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4474 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4475 {
4476 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4477 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4478 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4479 pixel = -1;
4480 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4481 }
4482 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4483 {
4484 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4485 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4486 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4487 pixel = -1;
4488 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4489 }
4490
4491 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4492 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4493 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4494 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4495 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4496 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4497 {
4498 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4499 ++ac;
4500 }
4501 else
4502 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4503 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4504 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4505 {
4506 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4507 the shadows. */
4508 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4509 ++ac;
4510
4511 /* Specify the colors. */
4512 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4513 if (pixel != -1)
4514 {
4515 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4516 ++ac;
4517 }
4518 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4519 if (pixel != -1)
4520 {
4521 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4522 ++ac;
4523 }
4524 }
4525 #endif
4526
4527 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4528 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4529
4530 {
4531 char *initial = "";
4532 char *val = initial;
4533 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4534 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4535 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4536 #endif
4537 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4538 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4539 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4540 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4541 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4542 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4543 }
4544 }
4545
4546 /* Define callbacks. */
4547 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4548 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4549 (XtPointer) bar);
4550
4551 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4552 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4553
4554 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4555
4556 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4557 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4558 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4559 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4560
4561 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4562 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4563 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4564 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4565
4566 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4567 }
4568 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4569
4570
4571 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4572 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4573
4574 #ifdef USE_GTK
4575 static void
4576 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4577 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4578 int portion, position, whole;
4579 {
4580 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4581 }
4582
4583 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4584 static void
4585 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4586 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4587 int portion, position, whole;
4588 {
4589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4590 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4591 float top, shown;
4592
4593 BLOCK_INPUT;
4594
4595 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4596
4597 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4598 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4599 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4600 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4601 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4602 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4603 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4604 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4605 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4606 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4607 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4608 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4609 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4610 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4611 whole += portion;
4612
4613 if (whole <= 0)
4614 top = 0, shown = 1;
4615 else
4616 {
4617 top = (float) position / whole;
4618 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4619 }
4620
4621 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4622 {
4623 int size, value;
4624
4625 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4626 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4627 value. */
4628 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4629 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4630 size = max (size, 1);
4631
4632 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4633 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4634 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4635
4636 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4637 }
4638 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4639
4640 if (whole == 0)
4641 top = 0, shown = 1;
4642 else
4643 {
4644 top = (float) position / whole;
4645 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4646 }
4647
4648 {
4649 float old_top, old_shown;
4650 Dimension height;
4651 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4652 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4653 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4654 XtNheight, &height,
4655 NULL);
4656
4657 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4658 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4659 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4660 else
4661 top = old_top;
4662 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4663 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4664
4665 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4666 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4667 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4668 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4669 {
4670 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4671 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4672 else
4673 {
4674 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4675 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4676 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4677
4678 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4679 }
4680 }
4681 }
4682 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4683
4684 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4685 }
4686 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4687
4688 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4689
4690
4691 \f
4692 /************************************************************************
4693 Scroll bars, general
4694 ************************************************************************/
4695
4696 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4697 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4698 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4699 scroll bar. */
4700
4701 static struct scroll_bar *
4702 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4703 struct window *w;
4704 int top, left, width, height;
4705 {
4706 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4707 struct scroll_bar *bar
4708 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4709
4710 BLOCK_INPUT;
4711
4712 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4713 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4714 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4715 {
4716 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4717 unsigned long mask;
4718 Window window;
4719
4720 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4721 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4722 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4723
4724 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4725 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4726 | ExposureMask);
4727 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4728
4729 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4730
4731 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4732 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4733 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4734 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4735 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4736 left, top, width,
4737 window_box_height (w), False);
4738
4739 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4740 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4741 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4742 top,
4743 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4744 height,
4745 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4746 0,
4747 CopyFromParent,
4748 CopyFromParent,
4749 CopyFromParent,
4750 /* Attributes. */
4751 mask, &a);
4752 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4753 }
4754 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4755
4756 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4757 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4758 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4759 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4760 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4761 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4762 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4763 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4764
4765 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4766 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4767 bar->prev = Qnil;
4768 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4769 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4770 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4771
4772 /* Map the window/widget. */
4773 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4774 {
4775 #ifdef USE_GTK
4776 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4777 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4778 top,
4779 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4780 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4781 max (height, 1));
4782 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4783 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4784 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4785 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4786 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4787 top,
4788 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4789 max (height, 1), 0);
4790 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4791 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4792 }
4793 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4794 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4795 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4796
4797 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4798 return bar;
4799 }
4800
4801
4802 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4803
4804 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4805 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4806 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4807 events.)
4808
4809 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4810 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4811 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4812 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4813 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4814
4815 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4816
4817 static void
4818 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4819 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4820 int start, end;
4821 int rebuild;
4822 {
4823 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4824 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4825 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4826 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4827
4828 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4829 if (! rebuild
4830 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4831 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4832 return;
4833
4834 BLOCK_INPUT;
4835
4836 {
4837 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4838 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4839 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4840
4841 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4842 the distance between start and end. */
4843 {
4844 int length = end - start;
4845
4846 if (start < 0)
4847 start = 0;
4848 else if (start > top_range)
4849 start = top_range;
4850 end = start + length;
4851
4852 if (end < start)
4853 end = start;
4854 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4855 end = top_range;
4856 }
4857
4858 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4859 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4860 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4861
4862 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4863 if (end > top_range)
4864 end = top_range;
4865
4866 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4867 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4868 that many pixels tall. */
4869 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4870
4871 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4872 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4873 if (0 < start)
4874 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4875 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4876 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4877 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4878 inside_width, start,
4879 False);
4880
4881 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4882 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4883 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4884 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4885
4886 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4887 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4888 /* x, y, width, height */
4889 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4890 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4891 inside_width, end - start);
4892
4893 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4894 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4895 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4896 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4897
4898 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4899 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4900 if (end < inside_height)
4901 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4902 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4903 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4904 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4905 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4906 False);
4907
4908 }
4909
4910 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4911 }
4912
4913 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4914
4915 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4916 nil. */
4917
4918 static void
4919 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4920 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4921 {
4922 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4923 BLOCK_INPUT;
4924
4925 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4926 #ifdef USE_GTK
4927 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4928 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4929 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4930 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4931 #else
4932 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4933 #endif
4934
4935 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4936 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4937
4938 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4939 }
4940
4941
4942 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4943 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4944 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4945 create one. */
4946
4947 static void
4948 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4949 struct window *w;
4950 int portion, whole, position;
4951 {
4952 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4953 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4954 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4955 int window_y, window_height;
4956
4957 /* Get window dimensions. */
4958 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4959 top = window_y;
4960 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4961 height = window_height;
4962
4963 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4964 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4965
4966 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4967 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4968 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4969 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4970 else
4971 sb_width = width;
4972
4973 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
4974 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4975 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4976 sb_left = (left +
4977 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
4978 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
4979 : 0));
4980 else
4981 sb_left = (left +
4982 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
4983 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
4984 : width - sb_width));
4985 #else
4986 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4987 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
4988 else
4989 sb_left = left;
4990 #endif
4991
4992 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
4993 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
4994 {
4995 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4996 {
4997 BLOCK_INPUT;
4998 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4999 left, top, width, height, False);
5000 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5001 }
5002
5003 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5004 }
5005 else
5006 {
5007 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5008 unsigned int mask = 0;
5009
5010 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5011
5012 BLOCK_INPUT;
5013
5014 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5015 mask |= CWX;
5016 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5017 mask |= CWY;
5018 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5019 mask |= CWWidth;
5020 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5021 mask |= CWHeight;
5022
5023 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5024
5025 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5026 if (mask)
5027 {
5028 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5029 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5030 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5031 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5032 left, top, width, height, False);
5033 #ifdef USE_GTK
5034 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5035 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5036 top,
5037 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5038 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5039 max (height, 1));
5040 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5041 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5042 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5043 top,
5044 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5045 max (height, 1), 0);
5046 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5047 }
5048 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5049
5050 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5051 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5052 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5053 {
5054 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5055 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5056 height, False);
5057 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5058 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5059 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5060 height, False);
5061 }
5062
5063 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5064 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5065 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5066 example. */
5067 {
5068 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5069 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5070 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5071 {
5072 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5073 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5074 left + area_width - rest, top,
5075 rest, height, False);
5076 else
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left, top, rest, height, False);
5079 }
5080 }
5081
5082 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5083 if (mask)
5084 {
5085 XWindowChanges wc;
5086
5087 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5088 wc.y = top;
5089 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5090 wc.height = height;
5091 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5092 mask, &wc);
5093 }
5094
5095 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5096
5097 /* Remember new settings. */
5098 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5099 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5100 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5101 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5102
5103 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5104 }
5105
5106 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5107 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5108 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5109 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5110 dragged. */
5111 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5112 {
5113 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5114
5115 if (whole == 0)
5116 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5117 else
5118 {
5119 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5120 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5121 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5122 }
5123 }
5124 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5125
5126 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5127 }
5128
5129
5130 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5131 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5132 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5133 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5134 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5135 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5136 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5137
5138 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5139 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5140 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5141
5142 static void
5143 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5144 FRAME_PTR frame;
5145 {
5146 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5147 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5148 {
5149 Lisp_Object bar;
5150 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5151 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5152 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5153 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5154 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5155 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5156 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5157 }
5158 }
5159
5160
5161 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5162 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5163
5164 static void
5165 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5166 struct window *window;
5167 {
5168 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5169 struct frame *f;
5170
5171 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5172 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5173 abort ();
5174
5175 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5176
5177 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5178 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5179 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5180 {
5181 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5182 the lists. */
5183 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5184 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5185 return;
5186 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5187 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5188 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5189 else
5190 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5191 one or the other! */
5192 abort ();
5193 }
5194 else
5195 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5196
5197 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5198 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5199
5200 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5201 bar->prev = Qnil;
5202 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5203 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5204 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5205 }
5206
5207 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5208 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5209
5210 static void
5211 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5212 FRAME_PTR f;
5213 {
5214 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5215
5216 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5217
5218 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5219 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5220 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5221
5222 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5223 {
5224 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5225
5226 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5227
5228 next = b->next;
5229 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5230 }
5231
5232 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5233 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5234 }
5235
5236
5237 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5238 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5239 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5240
5241 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5242 mark bits. */
5243
5244 static void
5245 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5246 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5247 XEvent *event;
5248 {
5249 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5250 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5251 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5252 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5253
5254 BLOCK_INPUT;
5255
5256 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5257
5258 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5259 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5260
5261 /* x, y, width, height */
5262 0, 0,
5263 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5264 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5265
5266 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5267
5268 }
5269 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5270
5271 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5272 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5273
5274 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5275 mark bits. */
5276
5277
5278 static void
5279 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5280 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5281 XEvent *event;
5282 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5283 {
5284 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5285 abort ();
5286
5287 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5288 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5289 emacs_event->modifiers
5290 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5291 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5292 event->xbutton.state)
5293 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5294 ? up_modifier
5295 : down_modifier));
5296 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5297 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5298 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5299 {
5300 #if 0
5301 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5302 int internal_height
5303 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5304 #endif
5305 int top_range
5306 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5307 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5308
5309 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5310 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5311
5312 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5313 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5314 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5315 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5316 else
5317 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5318
5319 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5320 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5321 whether or not we're dragging. */
5322 #if 0
5323 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5324 holding it. */
5325 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5326 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5327 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5328 #endif
5329
5330 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5331 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5332 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5333 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5334 {
5335 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5336 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5337
5338 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5339 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5340 }
5341 #endif
5342
5343 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5344 #if 0
5345 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5346 the handle. */
5347 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5348 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5349 else
5350 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5351 #else
5352 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5353 #endif
5354
5355 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5356 }
5357 }
5358
5359 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5360
5361 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5362
5363 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5364 mark bits. */
5365
5366 static void
5367 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5368 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5369 XEvent *event;
5370 {
5371 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5372
5373 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5374
5375 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5376 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5377
5378 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5379 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5380 {
5381 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5382 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5383
5384 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5385 {
5386 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5387
5388 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5389 }
5390 }
5391 }
5392
5393 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5394
5395 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5396 on the scroll bar. */
5397
5398 static void
5399 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5400 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5401 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5402 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5403 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5404 unsigned long *time;
5405 {
5406 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5407 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5408 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5409 int win_x, win_y;
5410 Window dummy_window;
5411 int dummy_coord;
5412 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5413
5414 BLOCK_INPUT;
5415
5416 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5417 report that. */
5418 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5419
5420 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5421 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5422 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5423
5424 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5425 &win_x, &win_y,
5426
5427 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5428 &dummy_mask))
5429 ;
5430 else
5431 {
5432 #if 0
5433 int inside_height
5434 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5435 #endif
5436 int top_range
5437 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5438
5439 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5440
5441 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5442 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5443
5444 if (win_y < 0)
5445 win_y = 0;
5446 if (win_y > top_range)
5447 win_y = top_range;
5448
5449 *fp = f;
5450 *bar_window = bar->window;
5451
5452 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5453 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5454 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5455 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5456 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5457 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5458 else
5459 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5460
5461 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5462 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5463
5464 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5465 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5466 }
5467
5468 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5469
5470 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5471 }
5472
5473
5474 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5475 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5476 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5477 redraw them. */
5478
5479 void
5480 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5481 FRAME_PTR f;
5482 {
5483 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5484 Lisp_Object bar;
5485
5486 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5487 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5488 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5489 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5490 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5491 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5492 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5493 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5494 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5495 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5496 }
5497
5498 \f
5499 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5500
5501 #if 0
5502 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5503 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5504 sometimes don't work. */
5505
5506 static Time enter_timestamp;
5507 #endif
5508
5509 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5510 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5511 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5512 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5513
5514 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5515 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5516
5517 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5518
5519 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5520 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5521
5522 static int temp_index;
5523 static short temp_buffer[100];
5524
5525 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5526 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5527 temp_index = 0; \
5528 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5529
5530 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5531 on a particular display. */
5532
5533 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5534
5535 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5536 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5537 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5538 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5539
5540 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5541
5542 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5543 do \
5544 { \
5545 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5546 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5547 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5548 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5549 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5550 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5551 } \
5552 while (0)
5553
5554 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5555 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5556
5557
5558 enum
5559 {
5560 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5561 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5562 X_EVENT_DROP
5563 };
5564
5565 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5566 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5567 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5568
5569 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5570 this event further.
5571 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5572
5573 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5574 static int
5575 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5576 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5577 XEvent *event;
5578 {
5579 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5580 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5581 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5582 was created. */
5583
5584 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5585 event->xclient.window);
5586
5587 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5588 }
5589 #endif
5590
5591 #ifdef USE_GTK
5592 static int current_count;
5593 static int current_finish;
5594 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5595
5596 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5597 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5598 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5599 static GdkFilterReturn
5600 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5601 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5602 GdkEvent *ev;
5603 gpointer data;
5604 {
5605 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5606
5607 if (current_count >= 0)
5608 {
5609 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5610
5611 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5612
5613 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5614 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5615 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5616 so we do it here. */
5617 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5618 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5619 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5620 #endif
5621
5622 if (! dpyinfo)
5623 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5624 else
5625 {
5626 current_count +=
5627 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5628 current_hold_quit);
5629 }
5630 }
5631 else
5632 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5633
5634 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5635 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5636
5637 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5638 }
5639 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5640
5641
5642 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5643
5644 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5645 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5646 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5647
5648 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5649
5650 static int
5651 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5652 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5653 XEvent *eventp;
5654 int *finish;
5655 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5656 {
5657 union {
5658 struct input_event ie;
5659 struct selection_input_event sie;
5660 } inev;
5661 int count = 0;
5662 int do_help = 0;
5663 int nbytes = 0;
5664 struct frame *f;
5665 struct coding_system coding;
5666 XEvent event = *eventp;
5667
5668 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5669
5670 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5671 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5672 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5673
5674 switch (event.type)
5675 {
5676 case ClientMessage:
5677 {
5678 if (event.xclient.message_type
5679 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5680 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5681 {
5682 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5683 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5684 {
5685 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5686 could be the shell widget window
5687 if the frame has no title bar. */
5688 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5689 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5690 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5691 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5692 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5693 #endif
5694 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5695 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5696 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5697 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5698 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5699 needed.
5700
5701 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5702 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5703 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5704 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5705 Emacs. */
5706
5707 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5708 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5709 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5710 if (f)
5711 {
5712 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5713 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5714 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5715 x_catch_errors (d);
5716 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5717 /* The ICCCM says this is
5718 the only valid choice. */
5719 RevertToParent,
5720 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5721 /* This is needed to detect the error
5722 if there is an error. */
5723 XSync (d, False);
5724 x_uncatch_errors ();
5725 }
5726 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5727 #endif /* 0 */
5728 goto done;
5729 }
5730
5731 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5732 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5733 {
5734 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5735 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5736 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5737 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5738 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5739 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5740 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5741 session manager and one for this. */
5742 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5743 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5744 #endif
5745 {
5746 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5747 event.xclient.window);
5748 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5749 for a single Emacs process. */
5750 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5751 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5752 event.xclient.window,
5753 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5754 else if (f)
5755 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5756 event.xclient.window,
5757 0, 0);
5758 }
5759 goto done;
5760 }
5761
5762 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5763 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5764 {
5765 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5766 event.xclient.window);
5767 if (!f)
5768 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5769
5770 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5771 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5772 goto done;
5773 }
5774
5775 goto done;
5776 }
5777
5778 if (event.xclient.message_type
5779 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5780 {
5781 goto done;
5782 }
5783
5784 if (event.xclient.message_type
5785 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5786 {
5787 int new_x, new_y;
5788 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5789
5790 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5791 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5792
5793 if (f)
5794 {
5795 f->left_pos = new_x;
5796 f->top_pos = new_y;
5797 }
5798 goto done;
5799 }
5800
5801 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5802 if (event.xclient.message_type
5803 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5804 {
5805 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5806 if (f)
5807 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5808 &event, NULL);
5809 goto done;
5810 }
5811 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5812
5813 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5814 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5815 || (event.xclient.message_type
5816 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5817 {
5818 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5819 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5820 currently never do because we are interested in
5821 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5822 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5823 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5824 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5825 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5826 goto done;
5827 }
5828
5829 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5830 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5831 we construct an input_event. */
5832 if (event.xclient.message_type
5833 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5834 {
5835 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5836 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5837 goto done;
5838 }
5839 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5840
5841 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5842
5843 if (!f)
5844 goto OTHER;
5845
5846 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5847 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5848 }
5849 break;
5850
5851 case SelectionNotify:
5852 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5853 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5854 goto OTHER;
5855 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5856 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5857 break;
5858
5859 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5860 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5861 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5862 goto OTHER;
5863 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5864 {
5865 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5866
5867 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5868 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5869 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5870 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5871 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5872 }
5873 break;
5874
5875 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5876 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5877 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5878 goto OTHER;
5879 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5880 {
5881 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5882 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5883
5884 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5885 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5886 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5887 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5888 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5889 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5890 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5891 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5892 }
5893 break;
5894
5895 case PropertyNotify:
5896 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5897 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5898 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5899 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5900 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5901 goto OTHER;
5902 #endif
5903 #endif
5904 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5905 goto OTHER;
5906
5907 case ReparentNotify:
5908 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5909 if (f)
5910 {
5911 int x, y;
5912 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5913 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5914 f->left_pos = x;
5915 f->top_pos = y;
5916
5917 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5918 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5919 }
5920 goto OTHER;
5921
5922 case Expose:
5923 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5924 if (f)
5925 {
5926 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5927
5928 #ifdef USE_GTK
5929 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5930 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5931 event.xexpose.window,
5932 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5933 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5934 FALSE);
5935 #endif
5936 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5937 {
5938 f->async_visible = 1;
5939 f->async_iconified = 0;
5940 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5941 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5942 }
5943 else
5944 expose_frame (f,
5945 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5946 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5947 }
5948 else
5949 {
5950 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5951 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5952 #endif
5953 #if defined USE_LUCID
5954 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5955 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5956 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5957 {
5958 Widget widget
5959 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
5960 if (widget)
5961 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
5962 }
5963 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
5964
5965 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5966 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
5967 goto OTHER;
5968 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5969 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
5970 event.xexpose.window);
5971
5972 if (bar)
5973 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
5974 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5975 else
5976 goto OTHER;
5977 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5978 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5979 }
5980 break;
5981
5982 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5983 source area was obscured or not
5984 available. */
5985 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
5986 if (f)
5987 {
5988 expose_frame (f,
5989 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
5990 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
5991 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
5992 }
5993 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5994 else
5995 goto OTHER;
5996 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5997 break;
5998
5999 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6000 source area was completely
6001 available. */
6002 break;
6003
6004 case UnmapNotify:
6005 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6006 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6007 {
6008 tip_window = 0;
6009 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6010 }
6011
6012 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6013 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6014 the frame was deleted. */
6015 {
6016 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6017 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6018 display that won't ever be seen. */
6019 f->async_visible = 0;
6020 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6021 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6022 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6023 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6024 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6025 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6026 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6027 {
6028 f->async_iconified = 1;
6029
6030 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6031 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6032 }
6033 }
6034 goto OTHER;
6035
6036 case MapNotify:
6037 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6038 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6039 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6040 goto OTHER;
6041
6042 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6043 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6044 frame is visible. */
6045 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6046 if (f)
6047 {
6048 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6049 the frame's display structures.
6050 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6051 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6052 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6053 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6054 if (! f->async_iconified)
6055 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6056
6057 f->async_visible = 1;
6058 f->async_iconified = 0;
6059 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6060
6061 if (f->iconified)
6062 {
6063 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6064 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6065 }
6066 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6067 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6068 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6069 to update the frame titles
6070 in case this is the second frame. */
6071 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6072 }
6073 goto OTHER;
6074
6075 case KeyPress:
6076
6077 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6078
6079 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6080 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6081 if (popup_activated ())
6082 goto OTHER;
6083 #endif
6084
6085 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6086
6087 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6088 && (f == 0
6089 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6090 {
6091 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6092 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6093 }
6094
6095 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6096 if (f == 0)
6097 {
6098 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6099 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6100 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6101 event.xkey.window);
6102 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6103 {
6104 widget = XtParent (widget);
6105 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6106 }
6107 }
6108 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6109
6110 if (f != 0)
6111 {
6112 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6113 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6114 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6115 his Emacs hang.
6116
6117 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6118 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6119 status_return even if the input is too long to
6120 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6121 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6122 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6123 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6124 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6125 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6126 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6127 int modifiers;
6128 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6129 Lisp_Object c;
6130
6131 #ifdef USE_GTK
6132 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6133 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6134 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6135 (see above). */
6136 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6137 #endif
6138
6139 event.xkey.state
6140 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6141 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6142 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6143
6144 /* This will have to go some day... */
6145
6146 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6147 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6148 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6149 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6150 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6151 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6152 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6153
6154 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6155 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6156 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6157 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6158 not it is combined with Meta. */
6159 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6160 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6161
6162 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6163 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6164 {
6165 Status status_return;
6166
6167 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6168 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6169 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6170 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6171 &status_return);
6172 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6173 {
6174 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6175 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6176 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6177 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6178 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6179 &status_return);
6180 }
6181 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6182 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6183 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6184 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6185 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6186 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6187 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6188 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6189 &status_return);
6190 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6191 {
6192 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6193 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6194 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6195 &event.xkey,
6196 copy_bufptr,
6197 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6198 &status_return);
6199 }
6200 }
6201 #endif
6202
6203 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6204 break;
6205 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6206 {
6207 keysym = NoSymbol;
6208 modifiers = 0;
6209 }
6210 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6211 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6212 abort ();
6213 }
6214 else
6215 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6216 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6217 &compose_status);
6218 #else
6219 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6220 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6221 &compose_status);
6222 #endif
6223
6224 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6225 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6226 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6227 break;
6228
6229 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6230 orig_keysym = keysym;
6231
6232 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6233 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6234 inev.ie.modifiers
6235 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6236 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6237
6238 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6239 translations to characters. */
6240 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6241 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6242 {
6243 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6244 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6245 goto done_keysym;
6246 }
6247
6248 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6249 if ((keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x010033ff)
6250 || (keysym >= 0x0100e000 && keysym <= 0x0100ffff))
6251 {
6252 int code = keysym & 0xFFFF, charset_id, c1, c2;
6253
6254 if (code < 0x80)
6255 {
6256 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6257 inev.ie.code = code;
6258 }
6259 else if (code < 0x100)
6260 {
6261 if (code < 0xA0)
6262 charset_id = CHARSET_8_BIT_CONTROL;
6263 else
6264 charset_id = charset_latin_iso8859_1;
6265 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6266 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, code, 0);
6267 }
6268 else
6269 {
6270 if (code < 0x2500)
6271 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff,
6272 code -= 0x100;
6273 else if (code < 0xE000)
6274 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff,
6275 code -= 0x2500;
6276 else
6277 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff,
6278 code -= 0xE000;
6279 c1 = (code / 96) + 32, c2 = (code % 96) + 32;
6280 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6281 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, c1, c2);
6282 }
6283 goto done_keysym;
6284 }
6285
6286 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6287 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6288 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6289 Vx_keysym_table,
6290 Qnil))))
6291 {
6292 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6293 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6294 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6295 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6296 goto done_keysym;
6297 }
6298
6299 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6300 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6301 || keysym == XK_Delete
6302 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6303 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6304 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6305 #endif
6306 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6307 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6308 #ifdef HPUX
6309 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6310 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6311 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6312 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6313 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6314 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6315 #endif
6316 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6317 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6318 #endif
6319 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6320 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6321 #endif
6322 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6323 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6324 #endif
6325 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6326 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6327 #endif
6328 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6329 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6330 #endif
6331 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6332 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6333 #endif
6334 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6335 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6336 #endif
6337 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6338 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6339 #endif
6340 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6341 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6342 #endif
6343 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6344 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6345 #endif
6346 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6347 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6348 #endif
6349 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6350 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6351 #endif
6352 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6353 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6354 #endif
6355 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6356 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6357 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6358 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6359 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6360 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6361 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6362 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6363 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6364 #endif
6365 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6366 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6367 #endif
6368 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6369 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6370 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6371 don't have real modifiers but
6372 should be treated similarly to
6373 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6374 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6375 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6376 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6377 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6378 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6379 #endif
6380 ))
6381 {
6382 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6383 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6384 key. */
6385 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6386 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6387 goto done_keysym;
6388 }
6389
6390 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6391 register int i;
6392 register int c;
6393 int nchars, len;
6394
6395 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6396 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6397 we used just above and the locale. */
6398 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6399 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6400 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6401 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6402 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6403 gives us composition information. */
6404 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6405
6406 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6407 {
6408 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6409 }
6410
6411 {
6412 /* Decode the input data. */
6413 int require;
6414 unsigned char *p;
6415
6416 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6417 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6418 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6419 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6420 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6421 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6422 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6423 nbytes = coding.produced;
6424 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6425 copy_bufptr = p;
6426 }
6427
6428 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6429 character events. */
6430 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6431 {
6432 if (nchars == nbytes)
6433 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6434 else
6435 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6436 nbytes - i, len);
6437 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6438 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6439 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6440 inev.ie.code = c;
6441 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6442 }
6443
6444 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6445 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6446 count += nbytes;
6447
6448 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6449
6450 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6451 break;
6452 }
6453 }
6454 done_keysym:
6455 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6456 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6457 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6458 client. */
6459 break;
6460 #else
6461 goto OTHER;
6462 #endif
6463
6464 case KeyRelease:
6465 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6466 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6467 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6468 client. */
6469 break;
6470 #else
6471 goto OTHER;
6472 #endif
6473
6474 case EnterNotify:
6475 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6476
6477 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6478
6479 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6480 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6481
6482 #if 0
6483 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6484 {
6485 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6486 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6487 || !(f->auto_lower)
6488 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6489 {
6490 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6491 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6492 }
6493 }
6494 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6495 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6496 #endif
6497
6498 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6499 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6500 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6501 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6502 #ifdef USE_GTK
6503 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6504 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6505 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6506 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6507 #endif
6508 goto OTHER;
6509
6510 case FocusIn:
6511 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6512 goto OTHER;
6513
6514 case LeaveNotify:
6515 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6516
6517 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6518 if (f)
6519 {
6520 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6521 {
6522 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6523 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6524 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6525 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6526 }
6527
6528 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6529 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6530 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6531 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6532 if (any_help_event_p)
6533 do_help = -1;
6534 }
6535 #ifdef USE_GTK
6536 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6537 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6538 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6539 #endif
6540 goto OTHER;
6541
6542 case FocusOut:
6543 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6544 goto OTHER;
6545
6546 case MotionNotify:
6547 {
6548 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6549 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6550
6551 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6552 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6553 f = last_mouse_frame;
6554 else
6555 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6556
6557 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6558 {
6559 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6560 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6561 }
6562
6563 if (f)
6564 {
6565
6566 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6567 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6568 {
6569 Lisp_Object window;
6570
6571 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6572 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6573 0, 0, 0, 0);
6574
6575 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6576 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6577 will be selected iff it is active. */
6578 if (WINDOWP (window)
6579 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6580 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6581 {
6582 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6583 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6584 }
6585
6586 last_window=window;
6587 }
6588 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6589 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6590 }
6591 else
6592 {
6593 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6594 struct scroll_bar *bar
6595 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6596 event.xmotion.window);
6597
6598 if (bar)
6599 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6600 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6601
6602 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6603 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6604 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6605 }
6606
6607 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6608 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6609 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6610 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6611 do_help = 1;
6612 goto OTHER;
6613 }
6614
6615 case ConfigureNotify:
6616 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6617 if (f)
6618 {
6619 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6620 #ifdef USE_GTK
6621 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6622 event.xconfigure.height);
6623 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6624 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6625 do this one, the right one will come later.
6626 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6627 need to reset it below. */
6628 int dont_resize
6629 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6630 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6631 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6632 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6633
6634 if (dont_resize)
6635 goto OTHER;
6636
6637 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6638 is called by the code that handles resizing
6639 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6640
6641 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6642 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6643 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6644 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6645 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6646 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6647 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6648 {
6649 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6650 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6651 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6652 }
6653 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6654 #endif
6655
6656 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6657 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6658
6659 #ifdef USE_GTK
6660 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6661 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6662 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6663 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6664 #endif
6665 {
6666 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6667 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6668 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6669
6670 x_check_expected_move (f);
6671 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6672 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6673 }
6674
6675 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6676 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6677 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6678 #endif
6679
6680 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6681 {
6682 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6683 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6684 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6685 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6686 }
6687 }
6688 goto OTHER;
6689
6690 case ButtonRelease:
6691 case ButtonPress:
6692 {
6693 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6694 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6695 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6696
6697 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6698 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6699
6700 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6701 && last_mouse_frame
6702 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6703 f = last_mouse_frame;
6704 else
6705 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6706
6707 if (f)
6708 {
6709 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6710 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6711 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6712 {
6713 Lisp_Object window;
6714 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6715 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6716
6717 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6718 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6719 {
6720 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6721 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6722 else
6723 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6724 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6725 event.xbutton.state));
6726 tool_bar_p = 1;
6727 }
6728 }
6729
6730 if (!tool_bar_p)
6731 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6732 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6733 {
6734 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6735 if (! popup_activated ())
6736 #endif
6737 {
6738 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6739 {
6740 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6741 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6742 {
6743 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6744 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6745 }
6746 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6747 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6748 }
6749 else
6750 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6751 }
6752 }
6753 }
6754 else
6755 {
6756 struct scroll_bar *bar
6757 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6758 event.xbutton.window);
6759
6760 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6761 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6762 scroll bars. */
6763 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6764 {
6765 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6766 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6767 }
6768 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6769 if (bar)
6770 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6771 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6772 }
6773
6774 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6775 {
6776 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6777 last_mouse_frame = f;
6778
6779 if (!tool_bar_p)
6780 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6781 }
6782 else
6783 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6784
6785 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6786 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6787 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6788 if (f != 0)
6789 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6790
6791 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6792 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6793 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6794 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6795 Instead, save it away
6796 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6797 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6798 if (
6799 #ifdef USE_GTK
6800 ! popup_activated ()
6801 &&
6802 #endif
6803 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6804 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6805 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6806 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6807 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6808 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6809 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6810 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6811 {
6812 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6813 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6814 #ifdef USE_GTK
6815 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6816 #endif
6817 }
6818 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6819 {
6820 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6821 goto OTHER;
6822 }
6823
6824 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6825 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6826 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6827 {
6828 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6829 {
6830 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6831 if (f->output_data.x)
6832 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6833 }
6834 else
6835 goto OTHER;
6836 }
6837 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6838 else
6839 goto OTHER;
6840 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6841 }
6842 break;
6843
6844 case CirculateNotify:
6845 goto OTHER;
6846
6847 case CirculateRequest:
6848 goto OTHER;
6849
6850 case VisibilityNotify:
6851 goto OTHER;
6852
6853 case MappingNotify:
6854 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6855 local cache. */
6856 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6857 {
6858 case MappingModifier:
6859 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6860 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6861 case MappingKeyboard:
6862 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6863 }
6864 goto OTHER;
6865
6866 default:
6867 OTHER:
6868 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6869 BLOCK_INPUT;
6870 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6871 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6872 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6873 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6874 break;
6875 }
6876
6877 done:
6878 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6879 {
6880 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6881 count++;
6882 }
6883
6884 if (do_help
6885 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6886 {
6887 Lisp_Object frame;
6888
6889 if (f)
6890 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6891 else
6892 frame = Qnil;
6893
6894 if (do_help > 0)
6895 {
6896 any_help_event_p = 1;
6897 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6898 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6899 }
6900 else
6901 {
6902 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6903 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6904 }
6905 count++;
6906 }
6907
6908 *eventp = event;
6909 return count;
6910 }
6911
6912
6913 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6914 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6915 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6916
6917 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6918 int
6919 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6920 XEvent *event;
6921 Display *display;
6922 {
6923 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6924 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6925
6926 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6927
6928 if (dpyinfo)
6929 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6930
6931 return finish;
6932 }
6933
6934
6935 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6936 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6937 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6938
6939 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6940 thus pretending to be `read'.
6941
6942 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6943
6944 static int
6945 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6946 register int sd;
6947 int expected;
6948 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6949 {
6950 int count = 0;
6951 XEvent event;
6952 int event_found = 0;
6953 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6954
6955 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6956 {
6957 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6958 return -1;
6959 }
6960
6961 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6962 BLOCK_INPUT;
6963
6964 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6965 input_signal_count++;
6966
6967 ++handling_signal;
6968
6969 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6970 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6971 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6972 {
6973 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6974 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6975 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6976 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6977 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6978 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6979 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6980 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
6981 #endif
6982
6983 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
6984 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
6985 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
6986 for X connections. */
6987 #ifndef SIGIO
6988 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
6989 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
6990 {
6991 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
6992 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
6993 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
6994 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
6995 }
6996 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
6997 #endif /* SIGIO */
6998 #endif
6999
7000 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7001 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7002 {
7003 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7004 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7005 }
7006
7007 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7008 {
7009 struct input_event inev;
7010 BLOCK_INPUT;
7011 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7012 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7013 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7014 {
7015 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7016 count++;
7017 }
7018 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7019 }
7020 #endif
7021
7022 #ifndef USE_GTK
7023 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7024 {
7025 int finish;
7026
7027 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7028
7029 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7030 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7031 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7032 break;
7033 #endif
7034 event_found = 1;
7035
7036 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7037
7038 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7039 goto out;
7040 }
7041 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7042 }
7043
7044 #ifdef USE_GTK
7045
7046 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7047 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7048 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7049 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7050
7051 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7052 from all displays. */
7053
7054 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7055 {
7056 current_count = count;
7057 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7058
7059 gtk_main_iteration ();
7060
7061 count = current_count;
7062 current_count = -1;
7063 current_hold_quit = 0;
7064
7065 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7066 break;
7067 }
7068 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7069
7070 out:;
7071
7072 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7073 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7074 if (! event_found)
7075 {
7076 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7077 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7078 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7079 x_noop_count++;
7080 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7081 {
7082 x_noop_count=0;
7083
7084 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7085 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7086
7087 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7088
7089 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7090 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7091 }
7092 }
7093
7094 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7095 raise it now. */
7096 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7097 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7098 {
7099 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7100 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7101 }
7102
7103 --handling_signal;
7104 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7105
7106 return count;
7107 }
7108
7109
7110
7111 \f
7112 /***********************************************************************
7113 Text Cursor
7114 ***********************************************************************/
7115
7116 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7117 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7118
7119 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7120 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7121 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7122
7123 static void
7124 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7125 struct window *w;
7126 struct glyph_row *row;
7127 int area;
7128 GC gc;
7129 {
7130 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7131 XRectangle clip_rect;
7132 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7133
7134 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7135
7136 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7137 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7138 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7139 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7140 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7141
7142 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7143 }
7144
7145
7146 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7147
7148 static void
7149 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7150 struct window *w;
7151 struct glyph_row *row;
7152 {
7153 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7154 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7155 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7156 int x, y, wd, h;
7157 XGCValues xgcv;
7158 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7159 GC gc;
7160
7161 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7162 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7163 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7164 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7165 return;
7166
7167 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7168 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7169 y = get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &h);
7170 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7171
7172 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7173 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7174 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7175 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7176 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7177 else
7178 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7179 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7180 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7181
7182 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7183 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7184 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7185 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7186 }
7187
7188
7189 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7190
7191 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7192 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7193 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7194 --gerd. */
7195
7196 static void
7197 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7198 struct window *w;
7199 struct glyph_row *row;
7200 int width;
7201 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7202 {
7203 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7204 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7205
7206 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7207 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7208 and mini-buffer. */
7209 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7210 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7211 return;
7212
7213 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7214 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7215 the bar might not be in the window. */
7216 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7217 {
7218 struct glyph_row *row;
7219 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7220 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7221 }
7222 else
7223 {
7224 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7225 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7226 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7227 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7228 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7229 XGCValues xgcv;
7230
7231 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7232 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7233 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7234 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7235 that the glyph is legible. */
7236 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7237 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7238 else
7239 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7240 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7241
7242 if (gc)
7243 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7244 else
7245 {
7246 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7247 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7248 }
7249
7250 if (width < 0)
7251 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7252 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7253
7254 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7255 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7256
7257 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7258 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7259 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7260 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7261 width, row->height);
7262 else
7263 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7264 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7265 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7266 row->height - width),
7267 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7268 width);
7269
7270 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7271 }
7272 }
7273
7274
7275 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7276
7277 static void
7278 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7279 struct frame *f;
7280 Cursor cursor;
7281 {
7282 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7283 }
7284
7285
7286 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7287
7288 static void
7289 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7290 struct frame *f;
7291 int x, y, width, height;
7292 {
7293 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7294 x, y, width, height, False);
7295 }
7296
7297
7298 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7299
7300 static void
7301 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7302 struct window *w;
7303 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7304 int x, y;
7305 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7306 int on_p, active_p;
7307 {
7308 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7309
7310 if (on_p)
7311 {
7312 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7313 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7314
7315 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7316 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7317 {
7318 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7319 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7320 }
7321 else
7322 switch (cursor_type)
7323 {
7324 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7325 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7326 break;
7327
7328 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7329 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7330 break;
7331
7332 case BAR_CURSOR:
7333 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7334 break;
7335
7336 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7337 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7338 break;
7339
7340 case NO_CURSOR:
7341 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7342 break;
7343
7344 default:
7345 abort ();
7346 }
7347
7348 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7349 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7350 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7351 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7352 #endif
7353 }
7354
7355 #ifndef XFlush
7356 if (updating_frame != f)
7357 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7358 #endif
7359 }
7360
7361 \f
7362 /* Icons. */
7363
7364 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7365
7366 int
7367 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7368 struct frame *f;
7369 Lisp_Object file;
7370 {
7371 int bitmap_id;
7372
7373 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7374 return 1;
7375
7376 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7377 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7378 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7379 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7380
7381 if (STRINGP (file))
7382 {
7383 #ifdef USE_GTK
7384 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7385 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7386 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7387 return 0;
7388 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7389 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7390 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7391 }
7392 else
7393 {
7394 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7395 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7396 {
7397 int rc = -1;
7398
7399 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7400 #ifdef USE_GTK
7401 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7402 return 0;
7403 #else
7404 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7405 if (rc != -1)
7406 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7407 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7408 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7409
7410 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7411 if (rc == -1)
7412 {
7413 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7414 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7415 if (rc == -1)
7416 return 1;
7417
7418 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7419 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7420 }
7421 }
7422
7423 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7424 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7425 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7426 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7427 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7428
7429 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7430 }
7431
7432 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7433 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7434
7435 return 0;
7436 }
7437
7438
7439 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7440 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7441
7442 int
7443 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7444 struct frame *f;
7445 char *icon_name;
7446 {
7447 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7448 return 1;
7449
7450 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7451 {
7452 XTextProperty text;
7453 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7454 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7455 text.format = 8;
7456 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7457 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7458 }
7459 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7460 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7461 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7462
7463 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7464 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7465 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7466 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7467
7468 return 0;
7469 }
7470 \f
7471 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7472
7473 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7474 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7475
7476 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7477 be called from a signal handler.
7478 */
7479
7480 struct x_error_message_stack {
7481 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7482 Display *dpy;
7483 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7484 };
7485 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7486
7487 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7488 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7489 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7490
7491 static void
7492 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7493 Display *display;
7494 XErrorEvent *error;
7495 {
7496 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7497 x_error_message->string,
7498 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7499 }
7500
7501 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7502 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7503 operating on.
7504
7505 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7506 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7507 stored in x_error_message_string.
7508
7509 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7510 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7511
7512 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7513
7514 void x_check_errors ();
7515
7516 void
7517 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7518 Display *dpy;
7519 {
7520 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7521
7522 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7523 XSync (dpy, False);
7524
7525 data->dpy = dpy;
7526 data->string[0] = 0;
7527 data->prev = x_error_message;
7528 x_error_message = data;
7529 }
7530
7531 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7532 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7533
7534 void
7535 x_uncatch_errors ()
7536 {
7537 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7538
7539 BLOCK_INPUT;
7540
7541 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7542 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7543 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7544 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7545
7546 tmp = x_error_message;
7547 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7548 xfree (tmp);
7549 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7550 }
7551
7552 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7553 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7554 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7555
7556 void
7557 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7558 Display *dpy;
7559 char *format;
7560 {
7561 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7562 XSync (dpy, False);
7563
7564 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7565 {
7566 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7567 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7568 x_uncatch_errors ();
7569 error (format, string);
7570 }
7571 }
7572
7573 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7574 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7575
7576 int
7577 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7578 Display *dpy;
7579 {
7580 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7581 XSync (dpy, False);
7582
7583 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7584 }
7585
7586 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7587
7588 void
7589 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7590 Display *dpy;
7591 {
7592 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7593 }
7594
7595 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7596
7597 void
7598 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7599 {
7600 while (x_error_message)
7601 x_uncatch_errors ();
7602 }
7603
7604 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7605
7606 int
7607 x_catching_errors ()
7608 {
7609 return x_error_message != 0;
7610 }
7611
7612 #if 0
7613 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7614 x_trace_wire ()
7615 {
7616 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7617 }
7618 #endif /* ! 0 */
7619
7620 \f
7621 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7622 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7623 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7624 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7625 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7626
7627 static SIGTYPE
7628 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7629 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7630 {
7631 #ifdef USG
7632 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7633 must reestablish each time */
7634 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7635 #endif /* USG */
7636 }
7637
7638 \f
7639 /************************************************************************
7640 Handling X errors
7641 ************************************************************************/
7642
7643 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7644
7645 static char *error_msg;
7646
7647 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7648 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7649 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7650
7651 static void
7652 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7653 {
7654 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7655 exit (70);
7656 }
7657
7658 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7659 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7660
7661 static SIGTYPE
7662 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7663 Display *dpy;
7664 char *error_message;
7665 {
7666 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7667 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7668
7669 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7670 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7671 handling_signal = 0;
7672
7673 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7674 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7675 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7676 the original message here. */
7677 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7678
7679 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7680 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7681 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7682
7683 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7684 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7685 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7686
7687 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7688 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7689
7690 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7691 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7692 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7693
7694 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7695 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7696 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7697 if (dpyinfo)
7698 {
7699 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7700 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7701 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7702 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7703 }
7704 #endif
7705
7706 #ifdef USE_GTK
7707 if (dpyinfo)
7708 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7709 #endif
7710
7711 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7712 if (dpyinfo)
7713 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7714
7715 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7716 that are on the dead display. */
7717 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7718 {
7719 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7720 minibuf_frame
7721 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7722 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7723 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7724 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7725 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7726 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7727 }
7728
7729 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7730 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7731 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7732 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7733 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7734 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7735 {
7736 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7737 trying to find a replacement. */
7738 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7739 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7740 }
7741
7742 if (dpyinfo)
7743 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7744
7745 x_uncatch_errors ();
7746
7747 if (x_display_list == 0)
7748 {
7749 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7750 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7751 exit (70);
7752 }
7753
7754 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7755 #ifdef SIGIO
7756 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7757 #endif
7758 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7759 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7760
7761 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7762 error ("%s", error_msg);
7763 }
7764
7765 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7766 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7767 static void x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error);
7768
7769 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7770 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7771
7772 static int
7773 x_error_handler (display, error)
7774 Display *display;
7775 XErrorEvent *error;
7776 {
7777 if (x_error_message)
7778 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7779 else
7780 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7781 return 0;
7782 }
7783
7784 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7785 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7786 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7787
7788 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7789
7790 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7791 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7792 #else
7793 #define NO_INLINE
7794 #endif
7795
7796 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7797
7798 #ifdef noinline
7799 #undef noinline
7800 #endif
7801
7802 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7803 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7804
7805 static void NO_INLINE
7806 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7807 Display *display;
7808 XErrorEvent *error;
7809 {
7810 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7811
7812 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7813 original error handler. */
7814
7815 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7816 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7817 buf, error->request_code);
7818 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7819 }
7820
7821
7822 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7823 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7824 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7825
7826 static int
7827 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7828 Display *display;
7829 {
7830 char buf[256];
7831
7832 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7833 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7834 return 0;
7835 }
7836 \f
7837 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7838
7839 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7840 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7841 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7842 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7843
7844 Lisp_Object
7845 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7846 struct frame *f;
7847 register char *fontname;
7848 {
7849 struct font_info *fontp
7850 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7851
7852 if (!fontp)
7853 return Qnil;
7854
7855 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7856 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7857 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7858
7859 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7860 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7861 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7862
7863 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7864
7865 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7866 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7867 {
7868 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7869 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7870 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7871 }
7872 else
7873 {
7874 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7875 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7876 }
7877
7878 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7879 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7880 {
7881 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7882 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7883 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7884 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7885 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7886 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7887
7888 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7889 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7890 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7891 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7892 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7893 }
7894
7895 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7896 }
7897
7898 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7899 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7900 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7901 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7902
7903 Lisp_Object
7904 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7905 struct frame *f;
7906 char *fontsetname;
7907 {
7908 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7909 Lisp_Object result;
7910
7911 if (fontset < 0)
7912 return Qnil;
7913
7914 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7915 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7916 to do. */
7917 return fontset_name (fontset);
7918
7919 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7920
7921 if (!STRINGP (result))
7922 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7923 return Qnil;
7924
7925 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7926 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7927
7928 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7929 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7930 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7931 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7932 #endif
7933
7934 return build_string (fontsetname);
7935 }
7936
7937 \f
7938 /***********************************************************************
7939 X Input Methods
7940 ***********************************************************************/
7941
7942 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7943
7944 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7945
7946 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7947 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7948 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7949
7950 static void
7951 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7952 XIM xim;
7953 XPointer client_data;
7954 XPointer call_data;
7955 {
7956 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7957 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7958
7959 BLOCK_INPUT;
7960
7961 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7962 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7963 {
7964 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7965 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7966 {
7967 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7968 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7969 }
7970 }
7971
7972 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7973 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7974 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7975 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7976 }
7977
7978 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7979
7980 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7981 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7982 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7983 #endif
7984
7985 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7986 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7987
7988 static void
7989 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7990 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7991 char *resource_name;
7992 {
7993 XIM xim;
7994
7995 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7996 if (use_xim)
7997 {
7998 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7999 EMACS_CLASS);
8000 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8001
8002 if (xim)
8003 {
8004 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8005 XIMCallback destroy;
8006 #endif
8007
8008 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8009 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8010
8011 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8012 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8013 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8014 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8015 #endif
8016 }
8017 }
8018
8019 else
8020 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8021 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8022 }
8023
8024
8025 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8026
8027 struct xim_inst_t
8028 {
8029 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8030 char *resource_name;
8031 };
8032
8033 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8034 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8035 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8036 when the callback was registered. */
8037
8038 static void
8039 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8040 Display *display;
8041 XPointer client_data;
8042 XPointer call_data;
8043 {
8044 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8045 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8046
8047 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8048 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8049 return;
8050
8051 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8052
8053 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8054 as they have no XIC. */
8055 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8056 {
8057 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8058
8059 BLOCK_INPUT;
8060 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8061 {
8062 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8063
8064 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8065 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8066 {
8067 create_frame_xic (f);
8068 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8069 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8070 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8071 {
8072 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8073 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8074 }
8075 }
8076 }
8077
8078 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8079 }
8080 }
8081
8082 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8083
8084
8085 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8086 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8087 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8088 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8089
8090 static void
8091 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8092 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8093 char *resource_name;
8094 {
8095 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8096 if (use_xim)
8097 {
8098 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8099 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8100 int len;
8101
8102 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8103 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8104 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8105 len = strlen (resource_name);
8106 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8107 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8108 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8109 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8110 xim_instantiate_callback,
8111 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8112 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8113 least, hence the configure test. */
8114 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8115 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8116 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8117 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8118 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8119
8120 }
8121 else
8122 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8123 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8124 }
8125
8126
8127 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8128
8129 static void
8130 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8131 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8132 {
8133 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8134 if (use_xim)
8135 {
8136 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8137 if (dpyinfo->display)
8138 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8139 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8140 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8141 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8142 if (dpyinfo->display)
8143 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8144 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8145 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8146 }
8147 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8148 }
8149
8150 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8151
8152
8153 \f
8154 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8155 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8156
8157 void
8158 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8159 struct frame *f;
8160 {
8161 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8162
8163 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8164 is already for the top-left corner. */
8165 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8166 return;
8167
8168 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8169 position that fits on the screen. */
8170 if (flags & XNegative)
8171 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8172 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8173
8174 {
8175 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8176
8177 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8178 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8179 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8180
8181 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8182 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8183 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8184 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8185 is right, though.
8186
8187 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8188 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8189
8190 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8191 #endif
8192
8193 if (flags & YNegative)
8194 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8195 }
8196
8197 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8198 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8199 so the flags should correspond. */
8200 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8201 }
8202
8203 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8204 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8205 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8206 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8207 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8208
8209 void
8210 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8211 struct frame *f;
8212 register int xoff, yoff;
8213 int change_gravity;
8214 {
8215 int modified_top, modified_left;
8216
8217 if (change_gravity > 0)
8218 {
8219 f->top_pos = yoff;
8220 f->left_pos = xoff;
8221 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8222 if (xoff < 0)
8223 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8224 if (yoff < 0)
8225 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8226 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8227 }
8228 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8229
8230 BLOCK_INPUT;
8231 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8232
8233 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8234 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8235
8236 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8237 {
8238 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8239 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8240 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8241 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8242 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8243 }
8244
8245 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8246 modified_left, modified_top);
8247
8248 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8249 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8250 {
8251 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8252 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8253 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8254 }
8255
8256 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8257 }
8258
8259 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8260 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8261 static void
8262 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8263 struct frame *f;
8264 {
8265 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8266 {
8267 int width, height, ign;
8268
8269 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8270
8271 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8272
8273 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8274 when setting WM manager hints.
8275 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8276 x_check_expected_move. */
8277 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8278 {
8279 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8280 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8281 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8282
8283 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8284 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8285 }
8286 }
8287 }
8288
8289 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8290 the window.
8291 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8292 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8293 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8294 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8295 static void
8296 x_check_expected_move (f)
8297 struct frame *f;
8298 {
8299 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8300 {
8301 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8302 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8303
8304 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8305 {
8306 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8307 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8308 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8309
8310 f->left_pos = expect_left;
8311 f->top_pos = expect_top;
8312 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 0);
8313 }
8314 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8315 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8316
8317 /* Just do this once */
8318 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8319 }
8320 }
8321
8322
8323 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8324 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8325 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8326 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8327
8328 static void
8329 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8330 struct frame *f;
8331 int change_gravity;
8332 int cols, rows;
8333 {
8334 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8335
8336 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8337 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8338 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8339 ? 0
8340 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8341 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8342 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8343
8344 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8345
8346 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8347 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8348
8349 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8350 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8351
8352 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8353 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8354 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8355
8356 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8357 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8358 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8359 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8360
8361 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8362 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8363 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8364 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8365 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8366
8367 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8368 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8369 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8370 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8371 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8372
8373 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8374 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8375 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8376 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8377 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8378
8379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8380 }
8381
8382
8383 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8384 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8385 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8386 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8387
8388 void
8389 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8390 struct frame *f;
8391 int change_gravity;
8392 int cols, rows;
8393 {
8394 BLOCK_INPUT;
8395
8396 #ifdef USE_GTK
8397 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8398 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8399 else
8400 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8401 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8402
8403 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8404 {
8405 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8406 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8407 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8408 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8409 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8410 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8411 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8412 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8413 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8414 }
8415 else
8416 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8417
8418 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8419
8420 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8421
8422 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8423
8424 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8425 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8426
8427 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8428 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8429 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8430 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8431 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8432
8433 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8434 }
8435 \f
8436 /* Mouse warping. */
8437
8438 void
8439 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8440 struct frame *f;
8441 int x, y;
8442 {
8443 int pix_x, pix_y;
8444
8445 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8446 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8447
8448 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8449 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8450
8451 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8452 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8453
8454 BLOCK_INPUT;
8455
8456 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8457 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8458 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8459 }
8460
8461 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8462
8463 void
8464 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8465 struct frame *f;
8466 int pix_x, pix_y;
8467 {
8468 BLOCK_INPUT;
8469
8470 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8471 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8472 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8473 }
8474 \f
8475 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8476
8477 void
8478 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8479 struct frame *f;
8480 {
8481 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8482 x_raise_frame (f);
8483 #endif
8484 #if 0
8485 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8486 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8487 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8488 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8489 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8490 #endif /* ! 0 */
8491 }
8492
8493 void
8494 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8495 struct frame *f;
8496 {
8497 #if 0
8498 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8499 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8500 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8501 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8502 #endif /* ! 0 */
8503 }
8504
8505 /* Raise frame F. */
8506
8507 void
8508 x_raise_frame (f)
8509 struct frame *f;
8510 {
8511 if (f->async_visible)
8512 {
8513 BLOCK_INPUT;
8514 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8515 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8516 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8517 }
8518 }
8519
8520 /* Lower frame F. */
8521
8522 void
8523 x_lower_frame (f)
8524 struct frame *f;
8525 {
8526 if (f->async_visible)
8527 {
8528 BLOCK_INPUT;
8529 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8530 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8531 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8532 }
8533 }
8534
8535 static void
8536 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8537 FRAME_PTR f;
8538 int raise_flag;
8539 {
8540 if (raise_flag)
8541 x_raise_frame (f);
8542 else
8543 x_lower_frame (f);
8544 }
8545 \f
8546 /* Change of visibility. */
8547
8548 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8549 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8550 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8551 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8552 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8553 finishes with it. */
8554
8555 void
8556 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8557 struct frame *f;
8558 {
8559 Lisp_Object type;
8560 int original_top, original_left;
8561 int retry_count = 2;
8562
8563 retry:
8564
8565 BLOCK_INPUT;
8566
8567 type = x_icon_type (f);
8568 if (!NILP (type))
8569 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8570
8571 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8572 {
8573 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8574 call x_set_offset a second time
8575 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8576 before the window gets really visible. */
8577 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8578 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8579 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8580
8581 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8582
8583 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8584 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8585 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8586 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8587 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8588 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8589 #ifdef USE_GTK
8590 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8591 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8592 #else
8593 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8594 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8595 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8596 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8597 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8598 to come back ok without this. */
8599 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8600 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8601 #endif
8602 }
8603
8604 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8605
8606 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8607 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8608 so that incoming events are handled. */
8609 {
8610 Lisp_Object frame;
8611 int count;
8612 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8613 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8614 will set it when they are handled. */
8615 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8616
8617 original_left = f->left_pos;
8618 original_top = f->top_pos;
8619
8620 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8621 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8622
8623 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8624
8625 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8626 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8627 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8628 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8629
8630 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8631 because the window manager may choose the position
8632 and we don't want to override it. */
8633
8634 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8635 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8636 && previously_visible)
8637 {
8638 Drawable rootw;
8639 int x, y;
8640 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8641
8642 BLOCK_INPUT;
8643
8644 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8645 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8646 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8647 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8648 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8649 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8650 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8651 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8652 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8653
8654 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8655 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8656 original_left, original_top);
8657
8658 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8659 }
8660
8661 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8662
8663 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8664 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8665 MapNotify at all.. */
8666 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8667 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8668 {
8669 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8670 x_sync (f);
8671
8672 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8673 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8674 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8675 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8676 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8677 probably a bug. */
8678 if (input_polling_used ())
8679 {
8680 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8681 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8682 handler reset it. */
8683 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8684 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8685 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8686 poll_for_input_1 ();
8687 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8688 }
8689
8690 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8691 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8692 }
8693
8694 /* 2000-09-28: In
8695
8696 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8697 (iconify-frame f)
8698 (raise-frame f))
8699
8700 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8701 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8702 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8703 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8704
8705 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8706 goto retry;
8707 }
8708 }
8709
8710 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8711
8712 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8713
8714 void
8715 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8716 struct frame *f;
8717 {
8718 Window window;
8719
8720 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8721 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8722
8723 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8724 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8725 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8726
8727 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8728 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8729 return;
8730 #endif
8731
8732 BLOCK_INPUT;
8733
8734 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8735 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8736 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8737 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8738 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8739 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8740
8741 #ifdef USE_GTK
8742 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8743 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8744 else
8745 #endif
8746 {
8747 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8748
8749 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8750 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8751 {
8752 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8753 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8754 }
8755 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8756
8757 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8758 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8759 {
8760 XEvent unmap;
8761
8762 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8763 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8764 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8765 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8766 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8767 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8768 False,
8769 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8770 &unmap))
8771 {
8772 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8773 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8774 }
8775 }
8776
8777 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8778 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8779 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8780 }
8781
8782 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8783 just by the event that we get from the server.
8784 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8785 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8786 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8787 f->visible = 0;
8788 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8789 f->async_visible = 0;
8790 f->async_iconified = 0;
8791
8792 x_sync (f);
8793
8794 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8795 }
8796
8797 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8798
8799 void
8800 x_iconify_frame (f)
8801 struct frame *f;
8802 {
8803 int result;
8804 Lisp_Object type;
8805
8806 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8807 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8808 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8809
8810 if (f->async_iconified)
8811 return;
8812
8813 BLOCK_INPUT;
8814
8815 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8816
8817 type = x_icon_type (f);
8818 if (!NILP (type))
8819 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8820
8821 #ifdef USE_GTK
8822 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8823 {
8824 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8825 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8826
8827 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8828 f->iconified = 1;
8829 f->visible = 1;
8830 f->async_iconified = 1;
8831 f->async_visible = 0;
8832 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8833 return;
8834 }
8835 #endif
8836
8837 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8838
8839 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8840 {
8841 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8842 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8843 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8844 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8845 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8846 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8847 so we have to record it here. */
8848 f->iconified = 1;
8849 f->visible = 1;
8850 f->async_iconified = 1;
8851 f->async_visible = 0;
8852 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8853 return;
8854 }
8855
8856 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8857 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8858 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8859 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8860
8861 if (!result)
8862 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8863
8864 f->async_iconified = 1;
8865 f->async_visible = 0;
8866
8867
8868 BLOCK_INPUT;
8869 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8870 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8871 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8872
8873 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8874 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8875 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8876 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8877
8878 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8879 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8880
8881 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8882 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8883 {
8884 XEvent message;
8885
8886 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8887 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8888 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8889 message.xclient.format = 32;
8890 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8891
8892 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8893 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8894 False,
8895 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8896 &message))
8897 {
8898 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8899 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8900 }
8901 }
8902
8903 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8904 IconicState. */
8905 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8906
8907 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8908 {
8909 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8910 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8911 }
8912
8913 f->async_iconified = 1;
8914 f->async_visible = 0;
8915
8916 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8917 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8918 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8919 }
8920
8921 \f
8922 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8923
8924 void
8925 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8926 struct frame *f;
8927 {
8928 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8929 Lisp_Object bar;
8930 struct scroll_bar *b;
8931
8932 BLOCK_INPUT;
8933
8934 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8935 commands to the X server. */
8936 if (dpyinfo->display)
8937 {
8938 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8939 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8940
8941 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8942 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8943 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8944 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8945 toolkit scroll bars. */
8946 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8947 {
8948 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8949 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8950 }
8951 #endif
8952
8953 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8954 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8955 free_frame_xic (f);
8956 #endif
8957
8958 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8959 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8960 {
8961 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8962 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8963 }
8964 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8965 we are using a toolkit. */
8966 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8967 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8968
8969 free_frame_menubar (f);
8970 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8971
8972 #ifdef USE_GTK
8973 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8974 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8975 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8976 {
8977 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8978 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8979 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8980 }
8981 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8982
8983 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8984 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8985 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8986
8987 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8988 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8989 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8990 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8991 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8992 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8993
8994 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8995 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8996 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8997 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8998 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8999 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9000 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9001 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9002 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9003 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9004 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9005 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9006 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9007 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9008 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9009
9010 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9011 free_frame_faces (f);
9012
9013 x_free_gcs (f);
9014 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9015 }
9016
9017 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9018 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9019
9020 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9021 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9022
9023 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9024 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9025 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9026 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9027 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9028 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9029
9030 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9031 {
9032 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9033 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9034 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9035 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9036 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9037 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9038 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9039 }
9040
9041 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9042 }
9043
9044
9045 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9046
9047 void
9048 x_destroy_window (f)
9049 struct frame *f;
9050 {
9051 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9052
9053 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9054 commands to the X server. */
9055 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9056 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9057
9058 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9059 }
9060
9061 \f
9062 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9063
9064 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9065 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9066 that the window now has.
9067 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9068 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9069 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9070
9071 #ifndef USE_GTK
9072 void
9073 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9074 struct frame *f;
9075 long flags;
9076 int user_position;
9077 {
9078 XSizeHints size_hints;
9079
9080 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9081 Arg al[2];
9082 int ac = 0;
9083 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9084 #endif
9085
9086 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9087
9088 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9089 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9090
9091 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9092 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9093
9094 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9095 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9096 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9097 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9098 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9099 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9100 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9101 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9102 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9103 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9104
9105 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9106 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9107 size_hints.max_width
9108 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9109 size_hints.max_height
9110 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9111
9112 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9113
9114 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9115 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9116 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9117 {
9118 int base_width, base_height;
9119 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9120
9121 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9122 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9123
9124 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9125
9126 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9127 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9128 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9129 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9130 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9131
9132 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9133 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9134 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9135
9136 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9137 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9138 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9139 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9140 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9141 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9142 #else
9143 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9144 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9145 #endif
9146 }
9147
9148 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9149 if (flags)
9150 {
9151 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9152 goto no_read;
9153 }
9154 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9155
9156 {
9157 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9158 long supplied_return;
9159 int value;
9160
9161 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9162 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9163 &supplied_return);
9164 #else
9165 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9166 #endif
9167
9168 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9169 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9170 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9171 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9172 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9173 #endif
9174
9175 if (flags)
9176 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9177 else
9178 {
9179 if (value == 0)
9180 hints.flags = 0;
9181 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9182 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9183 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9184 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9185 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9186 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9187 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9188 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9189 }
9190 }
9191
9192 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9193 no_read:
9194 #endif
9195
9196 #ifdef PWinGravity
9197 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9198 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9199
9200 if (user_position)
9201 {
9202 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9203 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9204 }
9205 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9206
9207 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9208 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9209 #else
9210 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9211 #endif
9212 }
9213 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9214
9215 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9216
9217 void
9218 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9219 struct frame *f;
9220 int state;
9221 {
9222 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9223 Arg al[1];
9224
9225 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9226 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9227 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9228 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9229
9230 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9231 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9232
9233 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9234 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9235 }
9236
9237 void
9238 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9239 struct frame *f;
9240 int pixmap_id;
9241 {
9242 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9243
9244 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9245 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9246 #endif
9247
9248 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9249 {
9250 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9251 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9252 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9253 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9254 }
9255 else
9256 {
9257 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9258 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9259 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9260 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9261 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9262 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9263 best to explicitly give up. */
9264 #if 0
9265 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9266 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9267 #else
9268 return;
9269 #endif
9270 }
9271
9272
9273 #ifdef USE_GTK
9274 {
9275 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9276 return;
9277 }
9278
9279 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9280
9281 {
9282 Arg al[1];
9283 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9284 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9285 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9286 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9287 }
9288
9289 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9290
9291 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9292 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9293
9294 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9295 }
9296
9297 void
9298 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9299 struct frame *f;
9300 int icon_x, icon_y;
9301 {
9302 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9303
9304 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9305 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9306 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9307
9308 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9309 }
9310
9311 \f
9312 /***********************************************************************
9313 Fonts
9314 ***********************************************************************/
9315
9316 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9317
9318 struct font_info *
9319 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9320 FRAME_PTR f;
9321 int font_idx;
9322 {
9323 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9324 }
9325
9326
9327 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9328
9329 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9330 to be listed.
9331
9332 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9333
9334 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9335 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9336 on how many fonts to match. */
9337
9338 Lisp_Object
9339 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9340 struct frame *f;
9341 Lisp_Object pattern;
9342 int size;
9343 int maxnames;
9344 {
9345 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9346 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9347 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9348 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9349 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9350 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9351 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9352
9353 if (size < 0)
9354 {
9355 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9356 size = 0;
9357 }
9358
9359 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9360 if (NILP (patterns))
9361 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9362
9363 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9364 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9365 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9366
9367 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9368 {
9369 int num_fonts;
9370 char **names = NULL;
9371
9372 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9373 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9374 The cache is an alist of the form:
9375 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9376 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9377 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9378 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9379 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9380 if (!NILP (list))
9381 {
9382 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9383 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9384 goto label_cached;
9385 }
9386
9387 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9388
9389 BLOCK_INPUT;
9390 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9391
9392 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9393 {
9394 XFontStruct *font;
9395 unsigned long value;
9396
9397 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9398 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9399 {
9400 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9401 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9402 font = NULL;
9403 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9404 }
9405
9406 if (font
9407 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9408 {
9409 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9410 int len = strlen (name);
9411 char *tmp;
9412
9413 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9414 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9415 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9416 if (len == 0)
9417 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9418 else
9419 {
9420 num_fonts = 1;
9421 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9422 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9423 simple var. */
9424 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9425 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9426 XFree (name);
9427 }
9428 }
9429 else
9430 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9431
9432 if (font)
9433 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9434 }
9435
9436 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9437 {
9438 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9439 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9440 if (maxnames < 0)
9441 {
9442 int limit;
9443
9444 for (limit = 500;;)
9445 {
9446 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9447 if (num_fonts == limit)
9448 {
9449 BLOCK_INPUT;
9450 XFreeFontNames (names);
9451 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9452 limit *= 2;
9453 }
9454 else
9455 break;
9456 }
9457 }
9458 else
9459 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9460 &num_fonts);
9461
9462 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9463 {
9464 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9465 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9466 names = NULL;
9467 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9468 }
9469 }
9470
9471 x_uncatch_errors ();
9472 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9473
9474 if (names)
9475 {
9476 int i;
9477
9478 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9479 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9480 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9481 {
9482 int width = 0;
9483 char *p = names[i];
9484 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9485
9486 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9487 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9488 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9489 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9490 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9491 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9492 while (*p)
9493 if (*p++ == '-')
9494 {
9495 dashes++;
9496 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9497 width = atoi (p);
9498 else if (dashes == 9)
9499 resx = atoi (p);
9500 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9501 average_width = atoi (p);
9502 }
9503
9504 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9505 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9506 {
9507 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9508 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9509 {
9510 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9511 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9512 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9513 >= 0))
9514 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9515 width of this font. */
9516 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9517 else
9518 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9519 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9520 }
9521 }
9522 }
9523
9524 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9525 {
9526 BLOCK_INPUT;
9527 XFreeFontNames (names);
9528 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9529 }
9530 }
9531
9532 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9533 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9534 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9535
9536 label_cached:
9537 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9538
9539 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9540 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9541 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9542 {
9543 int found_size;
9544
9545 tem = XCAR (list);
9546
9547 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9548 continue;
9549 if (!size)
9550 {
9551 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9552 continue;
9553 }
9554
9555 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9556 {
9557 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9558 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9559 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9560
9561 BLOCK_INPUT;
9562 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9563 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9564 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9565 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9566 {
9567 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9568 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9569 thisinfo = NULL;
9570 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9571 }
9572 x_uncatch_errors ();
9573 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9574
9575 if (thisinfo)
9576 {
9577 XSETCDR (tem,
9578 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9579 ? make_number (0)
9580 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9581 BLOCK_INPUT;
9582 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9583 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9584 }
9585 else
9586 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9587 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9588 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9589 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9590 }
9591
9592 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9593 if (found_size == size)
9594 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9595 else if (found_size > 0)
9596 {
9597 if (NILP (second_best))
9598 second_best = tem;
9599 else if (found_size < size)
9600 {
9601 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9602 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9603 second_best = tem;
9604 }
9605 else
9606 {
9607 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9608 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9609 second_best = tem;
9610 }
9611 }
9612 }
9613 if (!NILP (newlist))
9614 break;
9615 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9616 {
9617 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9618 break;
9619 }
9620 }
9621
9622 return newlist;
9623 }
9624
9625
9626 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9627
9628 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9629 font table. */
9630
9631 static void
9632 x_check_font (f, font)
9633 struct frame *f;
9634 XFontStruct *font;
9635 {
9636 int i;
9637 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9638
9639 xassert (font != NULL);
9640
9641 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9642 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9643 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9644 break;
9645
9646 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9647 }
9648
9649 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9650
9651 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9652 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9653 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9654 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9655 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9656
9657 static INLINE void
9658 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9659 XFontStruct *font;
9660 int *w, *h;
9661 {
9662 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9663 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9664
9665 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9666 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9667 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9668 if (*w <= 0)
9669 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9670 }
9671
9672
9673 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9674 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9675 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9676 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9677 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9678
9679 static int
9680 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9681 struct frame *f;
9682 {
9683 int i;
9684 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9685 XFontStruct *font;
9686 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9687 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9688
9689 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9690 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9691
9692 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9693 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9694 {
9695 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9696 int w, h;
9697
9698 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9699 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9700 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9701
9702 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9703 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9704 }
9705
9706 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9707 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9708
9709 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9710 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9711 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9712 }
9713
9714
9715 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9716 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9717 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9718 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9719
9720 struct font_info *
9721 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9722 struct frame *f;
9723 register char *fontname;
9724 int size;
9725 {
9726 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9727 Lisp_Object font_names;
9728
9729 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9730 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9731 we already have by comparing names. */
9732 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9733
9734 if (!NILP (font_names))
9735 {
9736 Lisp_Object tail;
9737 int i;
9738
9739 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9740 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9741 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9742 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9743 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9744 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9745 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9746 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9747 }
9748
9749 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9750 {
9751 char *full_name;
9752 XFontStruct *font;
9753 struct font_info *fontp;
9754 unsigned long value;
9755 int i;
9756
9757 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9758 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9759 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9760 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9761 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9762 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9763 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9764
9765 BLOCK_INPUT;
9766 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9767 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9768 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9769 {
9770 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9771 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9772 font = NULL;
9773 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9774 }
9775 x_uncatch_errors ();
9776 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9777 if (!font)
9778 return NULL;
9779
9780 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9781 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9782 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9783 break;
9784
9785 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9786 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9787 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9788 {
9789 int sz;
9790 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9791 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9792 dpyinfo->font_table
9793 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9794 }
9795
9796 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9797 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9798 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9799
9800 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9801 BLOCK_INPUT;
9802 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9803 fontp->font = font;
9804 fontp->font_idx = i;
9805 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9806 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9807
9808 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
9809 {
9810 /* Fixed width font. */
9811 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
9812 }
9813 else
9814 {
9815 XChar2b char2b;
9816 XCharStruct *pcm;
9817
9818 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
9819 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
9820 if (pcm)
9821 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
9822 else
9823 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9824
9825 fontp->average_width
9826 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
9827 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
9828 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
9829 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
9830 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
9831 {
9832 if (pcm)
9833 {
9834 int width = pcm->width;
9835 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
9836 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
9837 width += pcm->width;
9838 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
9839 }
9840 else
9841 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9842 }
9843 }
9844
9845 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9846 full_name = 0;
9847 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9848 {
9849 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9850 char *p = name;
9851 int dashes = 0;
9852
9853 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9854 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9855 so don't use it.
9856 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9857 stored in them. */
9858 while (*p)
9859 {
9860 if (*p == '-')
9861 dashes++;
9862 p++;
9863 }
9864
9865 if (dashes >= 13)
9866 {
9867 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9868 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9869 }
9870
9871 XFree (name);
9872 }
9873
9874 if (full_name != 0)
9875 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9876 else
9877 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9878
9879 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9880 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9881
9882 if (NILP (font_names))
9883 {
9884 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9885 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9886 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9887 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9888 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9889 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9890 Qnil);
9891
9892 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9893 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9894 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9895 make_number (fontp->size)),
9896 Qnil)),
9897 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9898 if (full_name)
9899 {
9900 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9901 Qnil);
9902 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9903 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9904 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9905 make_number (fontp->size)),
9906 Qnil)),
9907 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9908 }
9909 }
9910
9911 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9912 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9913 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9914 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9915 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9916 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9917 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9918 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9919 fontp->encoding[1]
9920 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9921 /* 1-byte font */
9922 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9923 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9924 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9925 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9926 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9927 /* 2-byte font */
9928 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9929 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9930 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9931 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9932 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9933 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9934 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9935 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9936 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9937 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9938 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9939 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9940 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9941
9942 fontp->baseline_offset
9943 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9944 ? (long) value : 0);
9945 fontp->relative_compose
9946 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9947 ? (long) value : 0);
9948 fontp->default_ascent
9949 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9950 ? (long) value : 0);
9951
9952 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9953 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9954 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9955 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9956 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9957 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9958 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9959 return fontp;
9960 }
9961 }
9962
9963
9964 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9965 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9966
9967 struct font_info *
9968 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9969 struct frame *f;
9970 register char *fontname;
9971 {
9972 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9973 int i;
9974
9975 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9976 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9977 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9978 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9979 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9980 return NULL;
9981 }
9982
9983
9984 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9985 `encoder' of the structure. */
9986
9987 void
9988 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9989 struct font_info *fontp;
9990 {
9991 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9992
9993 elt = Qnil;
9994 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9995 {
9996 elt = XCAR (list);
9997 if (CONSP (elt)
9998 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9999 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10000 >= 0)
10001 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10002 >= 0)))
10003 break;
10004 }
10005
10006 if (! NILP (list))
10007 {
10008 struct ccl_program *ccl
10009 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10010
10011 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10012 xfree (ccl);
10013 else
10014 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10015 }
10016 }
10017
10018
10019 \f
10020 /***********************************************************************
10021 Initialization
10022 ***********************************************************************/
10023
10024 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10025 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10026 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10027 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10028
10029 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10030 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10031 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10032
10033 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10034 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10035 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10036 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10037 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10038 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10039 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10040 };
10041 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10042
10043 static int x_initialized;
10044
10045 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10046 static int x_session_initialized;
10047 #endif
10048
10049 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10050 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10051 the screen number from the server number. */
10052 static int
10053 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10054 const char *name1, *name2;
10055 {
10056 int seen_colon = 0;
10057 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10058 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10059 int length_until_period = 0;
10060
10061 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10062 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10063 length_until_period++;
10064
10065 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10066 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10067 name1 += 4;
10068 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10069 name2 += 4;
10070 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10071 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10072 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10073 name1 += system_name_length;
10074 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10075 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10076 name2 += system_name_length;
10077 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10078 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10079 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10080 name1 += length_until_period;
10081 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10082 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10083 name2 += length_until_period;
10084
10085 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10086 {
10087 if (*name1 == ':')
10088 seen_colon++;
10089 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10090 return 1;
10091 }
10092 return (seen_colon
10093 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10094 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10095 }
10096 #endif
10097
10098 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10099 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10100 to 5. */
10101 static void
10102 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10103 unsigned long mask;
10104 int *bits;
10105 int *offset;
10106 {
10107 int nr = 0;
10108 int off = 0;
10109
10110 while (!(mask & 1))
10111 {
10112 off++;
10113 mask >>= 1;
10114 }
10115
10116 while (mask & 1)
10117 {
10118 nr++;
10119 mask >>= 1;
10120 }
10121
10122 *offset = off;
10123 *bits = nr;
10124 }
10125
10126 int
10127 x_display_ok (display)
10128 const char * display;
10129 {
10130 int dpy_ok = 1;
10131 Display *dpy;
10132
10133 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
10134 if (dpy)
10135 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
10136 else
10137 dpy_ok = 0;
10138 return dpy_ok;
10139 }
10140
10141 struct x_display_info *
10142 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10143 Lisp_Object display_name;
10144 char *xrm_option;
10145 char *resource_name;
10146 {
10147 int connection;
10148 Display *dpy;
10149 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10150 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10151
10152 BLOCK_INPUT;
10153
10154 if (!x_initialized)
10155 {
10156 x_initialize ();
10157 ++x_initialized;
10158 }
10159
10160 #ifdef USE_GTK
10161 {
10162 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10163 int argc;
10164 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10165 char **argv2 = argv;
10166 GdkAtom atom;
10167
10168 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10169 {
10170 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10171 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10172 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10173 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10174 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10175 }
10176 else
10177 {
10178 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10179 argv[argc] = 0;
10180
10181 argc = 0;
10182 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10183
10184 if (! NILP (display_name))
10185 {
10186 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10187 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10188 }
10189
10190 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10191 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10192
10193 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10194 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10195 #endif
10196
10197 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10198
10199 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10200 fixup_locale ();
10201 xg_initialize ();
10202
10203 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10204
10205 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10206 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10207
10208 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10209 {
10210 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10211 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10212
10213 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10214 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10215
10216 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10217 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10218 }
10219
10220 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10221 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10222 }
10223 }
10224 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10225 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10226 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10227 errors with X11R5:
10228 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10229 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10230 So let's not use it until R6. */
10231 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10232 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10233 #endif
10234
10235 {
10236 int argc = 0;
10237 char *argv[3];
10238
10239 argv[0] = "";
10240 argc = 1;
10241 if (xrm_option)
10242 {
10243 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10244 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10245 }
10246 turn_on_atimers (0);
10247 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10248 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10249 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10250 &argc, argv);
10251 turn_on_atimers (1);
10252
10253 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10254 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10255 fixup_locale ();
10256 #endif
10257 }
10258
10259 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10260 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10261 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10262 #endif
10263 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10264 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10265 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10266
10267 /* Detect failure. */
10268 if (dpy == 0)
10269 {
10270 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10271 return 0;
10272 }
10273
10274 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10275
10276 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10277 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10278
10279 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10280 {
10281 struct x_display_info *share;
10282 Lisp_Object tail;
10283
10284 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10285 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10286 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10287 SDATA (display_name)))
10288 break;
10289 if (share)
10290 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10291 else
10292 {
10293 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10294 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10295 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10296 {
10297 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10298 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10299 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10300 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10301 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10302 BLOCK_INPUT;
10303 }
10304
10305 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10306 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10307 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10308 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10309 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10310 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10311 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10312 }
10313 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10314 }
10315 #endif
10316
10317 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10318 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10319 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10320
10321 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10322 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10323 x_display_name_list);
10324 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10325
10326 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10327
10328 #if 0
10329 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10330 #endif /* ! 0 */
10331
10332 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10333 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10334 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10335 + 2);
10336 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10337 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10338
10339 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10340 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10341
10342 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10343 #ifdef USE_GTK
10344 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10345 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10346 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10347
10348 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10349 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10350
10351 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10352 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10353 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10354 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10355 #else
10356 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10357 #endif
10358 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10359 all versions. */
10360 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10361
10362 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10363 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10364 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10365 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10366 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10367 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10368 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10369 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10370 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10371 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10372 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10373 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10374 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10375 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10376 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10377 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10378 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10379 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10380 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10381 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10382 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10383 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10384 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10385 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10386 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10387 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10388 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10389 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10390 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10391 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10392 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10393 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10394 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10395
10396 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10397 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10398 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10399
10400 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10401 {
10402 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10403 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10404 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10405 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10406 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10407 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10408 }
10409
10410 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10411 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10412 {
10413 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10414 {
10415 Lisp_Object value;
10416 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10417 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10418 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10419 Qnil, Qnil);
10420 if (STRINGP (value)
10421 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10422 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10423 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10424 }
10425 }
10426 else
10427 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10428 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10429
10430 {
10431 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10432 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10433 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10434 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10435 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10436 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10437 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10438 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10439 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10440 }
10441
10442 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10443 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10444 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10445 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10446 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10447 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10448 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10449 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10450 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10451 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10452 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10453 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10454 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10455 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10456 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10457 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10458 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10459 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10460 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10461 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10462 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10463 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10464 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10465 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10466 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10467 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10468 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10469 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10470 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10471 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10472 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10473 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10474 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10475 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10476 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10477 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10478 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10479 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10480 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10481 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10482 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10483 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10484 /* For properties of font. */
10485 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10486 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10487 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10488 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10489 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10490 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10491 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10492 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10493 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10494 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10495
10496 /* Ghostscript support. */
10497 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10498 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10499
10500 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10501 False);
10502
10503 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10504
10505 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10506 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10507
10508 {
10509 char null_bits[1];
10510
10511 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10512
10513 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10514 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10515 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10516 1);
10517 }
10518
10519 {
10520 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10521 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10522 dpyinfo->gray
10523 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10524 gray_bitmap_bits,
10525 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10526 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10527 }
10528
10529 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10530 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10531 #endif
10532
10533 #ifdef subprocesses
10534 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10535 if (connection != 0)
10536 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10537 #endif
10538
10539 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10540 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10541 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10542 /* stdin is a socket here */
10543 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10544 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10545 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10546 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10547 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10548 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10549
10550 #ifdef SIGIO
10551 if (interrupt_input)
10552 init_sigio (connection);
10553 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10554
10555 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10556 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10557 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10558 so that Xt does not crash. */
10559 {
10560 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10561 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10562 Font font;
10563
10564 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10565 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10566 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10567 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10568 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10569 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10570 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10571 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10572 abort ();
10573 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10574 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10575 x_uncatch_errors ();
10576 }
10577 #endif
10578 #endif
10579
10580 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10581 for debugging X code. */
10582 {
10583 Lisp_Object value;
10584 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10585 build_string ("synchronous"),
10586 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10587 Qnil, Qnil);
10588 if (STRINGP (value)
10589 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10590 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10591 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10592 }
10593
10594 {
10595 Lisp_Object value;
10596 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10597 build_string ("useXIM"),
10598 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10599 Qnil, Qnil);
10600 #ifdef USE_XIM
10601 if (STRINGP (value)
10602 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10603 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10604 use_xim = 0;
10605 #else
10606 if (STRINGP (value)
10607 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10608 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10609 use_xim = 1;
10610 #endif
10611 }
10612
10613 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10614 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10615 if (!x_session_initialized++)
10616 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10617 #endif
10618
10619 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10620
10621 return dpyinfo;
10622 }
10623 \f
10624 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10625 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10626
10627 void
10628 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10629 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10630 {
10631 int i;
10632
10633 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10634
10635 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10636 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10637 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10638 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10639 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10640 else
10641 {
10642 Lisp_Object tail;
10643
10644 tail = x_display_name_list;
10645 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10646 {
10647 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10648 {
10649 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10650 break;
10651 }
10652 tail = XCDR (tail);
10653 }
10654 }
10655
10656 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10657 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10658
10659 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10660 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10661 else
10662 {
10663 struct x_display_info *tail;
10664
10665 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10666 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10667 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10668 }
10669
10670 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10671 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10672 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10673 #endif
10674 #endif
10675 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10676 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10677 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10678 #endif
10679 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10680 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10681 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10682 #endif
10683
10684 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10685 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10686 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10687 {
10688 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10689 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10690 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10691 }
10692
10693 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10694 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10695
10696 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10697 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10698 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10699 xfree (dpyinfo);
10700 }
10701
10702 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10703
10704 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10705 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10706 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10707 that slows us down. */
10708
10709 static void
10710 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10711 struct atimer *timer;
10712 {
10713 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10714 {
10715 BLOCK_INPUT;
10716 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10717 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10718 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10719 }
10720 }
10721
10722 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10723
10724 \f
10725 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10726
10727 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10728
10729 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10730 {
10731 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10732 x_produce_glyphs,
10733 x_write_glyphs,
10734 x_insert_glyphs,
10735 x_clear_end_of_line,
10736 x_scroll_run,
10737 x_after_update_window_line,
10738 x_update_window_begin,
10739 x_update_window_end,
10740 x_cursor_to,
10741 x_flush,
10742 #ifdef XFlush
10743 x_flush,
10744 #else
10745 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10746 #endif
10747 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10748 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10749 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10750 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10751 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10752 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10753 x_per_char_metric,
10754 x_encode_char,
10755 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10756 x_draw_glyph_string,
10757 x_define_frame_cursor,
10758 x_clear_frame_area,
10759 x_draw_window_cursor,
10760 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10761 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10762 };
10763
10764 void
10765 x_initialize ()
10766 {
10767 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10768
10769 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10770 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10771 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10772 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10773 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10774 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10775 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10776 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10777 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10778 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10779 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10780 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10781 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10782 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10783 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10784 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10785 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10786 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10787
10788 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10789 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10790 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10791 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10792 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10793 off the bottom */
10794 baud_rate = 19200;
10795
10796 x_noop_count = 0;
10797 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10798 any_help_event_p = 0;
10799 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10800 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10801 x_session_initialized = 0;
10802 #endif
10803
10804 #ifdef USE_GTK
10805 current_count = -1;
10806 #endif
10807
10808 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10809 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10810
10811 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10812 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10813
10814 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10815
10816 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10817 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10818 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10819 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10820 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10821 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10822 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10823
10824 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10825
10826 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10827 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10828 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10829 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10830 widgets don't behave normally. */
10831 {
10832 EMACS_TIME interval;
10833 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10834 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10835 }
10836 #endif
10837
10838 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10839 #ifndef USE_GTK
10840 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10841 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10842 #endif
10843 #endif
10844
10845 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10846 original error handler. */
10847 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10848 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10849
10850 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10851 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10852 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10853 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10854
10855 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10856 }
10857
10858
10859 void
10860 syms_of_xterm ()
10861 {
10862 x_error_message = NULL;
10863
10864 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10865 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10866
10867 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10868 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10869
10870 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10871 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10872
10873 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10874 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10875 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10876 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10877
10878 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10879 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10880
10881 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10882 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10883 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10884 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10885 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10886 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10887 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10888
10889 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10890 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10891 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10892 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10893 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10894 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10895 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10896 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10897 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10898
10899 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10900 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10901 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10902 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10903 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10904 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10905 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10906 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10907 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10908 #elif USE_GTK
10909 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10910 #else
10911 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10912 #endif
10913 #else
10914 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10915 #endif
10916
10917 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10918 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10919
10920 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10921 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10922 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10923 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10924 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10925 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10926 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10927 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10928 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10929
10930 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10931 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10932 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10933 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10934 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10935 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10936
10937 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10938 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10939 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10940 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10941 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10942 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10943
10944 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10945 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10946 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10947 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10948 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10949 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10950
10951 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10952 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10953 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10954 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10955 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10956 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10957
10958 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10959 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10960 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10961 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10962 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10963 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10964 }
10965
10966 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10967
10968 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10969 (do not change this comment) */